Add support for auto-generating info/dir
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / org.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 8.2.4
6
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
11
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers web page}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
18 @c %**end of header
19 @finalout
20
21
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
23
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
26
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
29
30 @set cmdnames
31
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
33
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
45
46 @c a key but no command
47 @c Inserts: @item key
48 @macro orgkey{key}
49 @kindex \key\
50 @item @kbd{\key\}
51 @end macro
52
53 @macro xorgkey{key}
54 @kindex \key\
55 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
56 @end macro
57
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
61 @ifset cmdnames
62 @kindex \key\
63 @findex \command\
64 @iftex
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
66 @end iftex
67 @ifnottex
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
69 @end ifnottex
70 @end ifset
71 @ifclear cmdnames
72 @kindex \key\
73 @item @kbd{\key\}
74 @end ifclear
75 @end macro
76
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
80 @ifset cmdnames
81 @kindex \key\
82 @findex \command\
83 @iftex
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
85 @end iftex
86 @ifnottex
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
88 @end ifnottex
89 @end ifset
90 @ifclear cmdnames
91 @kindex \key\
92 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
93 @end ifclear
94 @end macro
95
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
99 @ifset cmdnames
100 @findex \command\
101 @iftex
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
103 @end iftex
104 @ifnottex
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
106 @end ifnottex
107 @end ifset
108 @ifclear cmdnames
109 @item @kbd{\key\}
110 @end ifclear
111 @end macro
112
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
116 @ifset cmdnames
117 @kindex \key\
118 @findex \command\
119 @iftex
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
121 @end iftex
122 @ifnottex
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
124 @end ifnottex
125 @end ifset
126 @ifclear cmdnames
127 @kindex \key\
128 @item @kbd{\text\}
129 @end ifclear
130 @end macro
131
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
135 @ifset cmdnames
136 @kindex \key1\
137 @kindex \key2\
138 @findex \command\
139 @iftex
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
141 @end iftex
142 @ifnottex
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
144 @end ifnottex
145 @end ifset
146 @ifclear cmdnames
147 @kindex \key1\
148 @kindex \key2\
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
150 @end ifclear
151 @end macro
152
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
154 @c @itemx
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
158 @ifset cmdnames
159 @kindex \key1\
160 @kindex \key2\
161 @findex \command\
162 @iftex
163 @item @kbd{\key1\}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
165 @end iftex
166 @ifnottex
167 @item @kbd{\key1\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
169 @end ifnottex
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear cmdnames
172 @kindex \key1\
173 @kindex \key2\
174 @item @kbd{\key1\}
175 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
176 @end ifclear
177 @end macro
178
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
182 @ifset cmdnames
183 @kindex \key1\
184 @kindex \key2\
185 @findex \command\
186 @iftex
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
188 @end iftex
189 @ifnottex
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
191 @end ifnottex
192 @end ifset
193 @ifclear cmdnames
194 @kindex \key1\
195 @kindex \key2\
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
197 @end ifclear
198 @end macro
199
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
203 @ifset cmdnames
204 @kindex \key1\
205 @kindex \key2\
206 @findex \command\
207 @iftex
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
209 @end iftex
210 @ifnottex
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
212 @end ifnottex
213 @end ifset
214 @ifclear cmdnames
215 @kindex \key1\
216 @kindex \key2\
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
218 @end ifclear
219 @end macro
220
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
225 @ifset cmdnames
226 @kindex \key1\
227 @kindex \key2\
228 @findex \command1\
229 @findex \command2\
230 @iftex
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
233 @end iftex
234 @ifnottex
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
237 @end ifnottex
238 @end ifset
239 @ifclear cmdnames
240 @kindex \key1\
241 @kindex \key2\
242 @item @kbd{\key1\}
243 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
244 @end ifclear
245 @end macro
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
247
248 @iftex
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
250 @end iftex
251
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
254 @ifinfo
255 @subsubheading \text\
256 @end ifinfo
257 @ifnotinfo
258 @item @b{\text\}
259 @end ifnotinfo
260 @end macro
261
262 @copying
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
264
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
266
267 @quotation
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
274
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual.''
277 @end quotation
278 @end copying
279
280 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
281 @direntry
282 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer.
283 @end direntry
284
285 @titlepage
286 @title The Org Manual
287
288 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
289 @author by Carsten Dominik
290 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan
291 Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye, Jambunathan K and Nicolas Goaziou.
292
293 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
294 @page
295 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
296 @insertcopying
297 @end titlepage
298
299 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
300 @contents
301
302 @ifnottex
303 @c FIXME These hand-written next,prev,up node pointers make editing a lot
304 @c harder. There should be no need for them, makeinfo can do it
305 @c automatically for any document with a normal structure.
306 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
307 @top Org Mode Manual
308
309 @insertcopying
310 @end ifnottex
311
312 @menu
313 * Introduction:: Getting started
314 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
315 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
316 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
317 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
318 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
319 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
320 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
321 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
322 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
323 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
324 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing notes
325 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
326 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
327 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
328 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
329 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
330 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
331 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
332 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
333 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
334 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
335 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
336
337 @detailmenu
338 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
339
340 Introduction
341
342 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
343 * Installation:: Installing Org
344 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
345 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
346 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
347
348 Document structure
349
350 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
351 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
352 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
353 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
354 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
355 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
356 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
357 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
358 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
359 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
360 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
361 * Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax
362
363 Visibility cycling
364
365 * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states
366 * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state
367 * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts
368
369 Global and local cycling
370
371 * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state
372 * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts
373
374 Tables
375
376 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
377 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
378 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
379 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
380 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
381 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
382
383 The spreadsheet
384
385 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
386 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
387 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
388 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
389 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
390 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
391 * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables
392 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
393 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
394 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
395
396 Hyperlinks
397
398 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
399 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
400 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
401 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
402 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
403 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
404 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
405 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
406
407 Internal links
408
409 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
410
411 TODO items
412
413 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
414 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
415 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
416 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
417 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
418 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
419
420 Extended use of TODO keywords
421
422 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
423 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
424 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
425 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
426 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
427 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
428 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
429
430 Progress logging
431
432 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
433 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
434 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
435
436 Tags
437
438 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
439 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
440 * Tag groups:: Use one tag to search for several tags
441 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
442
443 Properties and columns
444
445 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
446 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
447 * Property searches:: Matching property values
448 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
449 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
450 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
451
452 Column view
453
454 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
455 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
456 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
457
458 Defining columns
459
460 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
461 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
462
463 Dates and times
464
465 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
466 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
467 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
468 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
469 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
470 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
471 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
472
473 Creating timestamps
474
475 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
476 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
477
478 Deadlines and scheduling
479
480 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
481 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
482
483 Clocking work time
484
485 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
486 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
487 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
488
489 Capture - Refile - Archive
490
491 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
492 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
493 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
494 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
495 * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another
496 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
497
498 Capture
499
500 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
501 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
502 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
503
504 Capture templates
505
506 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
507 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
508 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
509
510 Archiving
511
512 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
513 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
514
515 Agenda views
516
517 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
518 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
519 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
520 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
521 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
522 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
523 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
524 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
525
526 The built-in agenda views
527
528 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
529 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
530 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
531 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
532 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
533 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
534
535 Presentation and sorting
536
537 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
538 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
539 * Sorting agenda items:: The order of things
540 * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda
541
542 Custom agenda views
543
544 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
545 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
546 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
547
548 Markup for rich export
549
550 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
551 * Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism
552 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
553 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
554 * Index entries:: Making an index
555 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates
556 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
557 * Special blocks:: Containers targeted at export back-ends
558
559 Structural markup elements
560
561 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
562 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
563 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
564 * Lists:: Lists
565 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
566 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
567 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
568 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
569 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
570
571 Embedded @LaTeX{}
572
573 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
574 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
575 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
576 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
577 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
578
579 Exporting
580
581 * The Export Dispatcher:: The main exporter interface
582 * Export back-ends:: Built-in export formats
583 * Export settings:: Generic export settings
584 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
585 * Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation
586 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
587 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
588 * Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown
589 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
590 * iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar
591 * Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to @code{Texinfo}, a man page, or Org
592 * Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables in lists in Org syntax
593 * Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output
594
595 HTML export
596
597 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
598 * HTML doctypes:: Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors
599 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
600 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
601 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
602 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
603 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
604 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
605 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
606 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
607 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
608
609 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
610
611 * @LaTeX{} export commands:: How to export to LaTeX and PDF
612 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
613 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
614 * @LaTeX{} specific attributes:: Controlling @LaTeX{} output
615
616 OpenDocument Text export
617
618 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
619 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
620 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
621 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
622 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
623 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
624 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
625 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
626 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
627 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
628 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
629
630 Math formatting in ODT export
631
632 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
633 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
634
635 Advanced topics in ODT export
636
637 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
638 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
639 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
640 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
641 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
642
643 Publishing
644
645 * Configuration:: Defining projects
646 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
647 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
648 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
649
650 Configuration
651
652 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
653 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
654 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
655 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
656 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
657 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
658 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
659 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
660
661 Sample configuration
662
663 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
664 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
665
666 Working with source code
667
668 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
669 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
670 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
671 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
672 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
673 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
674 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
675 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
676 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
677 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
678 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
679 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
680
681 Header arguments
682
683 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
684 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
685
686 Using header arguments
687
688 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
689 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
690 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
691 * Language-specific header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set language-specific default values for a buffer or heading
692 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
693 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
694
695 Specific header arguments
696
697 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
698 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
699 be collected and handled
700 * file:: Specify a path for file output
701 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
702 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
703 directory for code block execution
704 * exports:: Export code and/or results
705 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
706 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
707 files during tangling
708 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
709 code files
710 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
711 code files
712 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
713 expansion during tangling
714 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
715 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
716 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
717 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
718 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
719 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
720 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
721 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
722 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
723 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
724 * tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files
725 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
726 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
727 * post:: Post processing of code block results
728 * prologue:: Text to prepend to code block body
729 * epilogue:: Text to append to code block body
730
731 Miscellaneous
732
733 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
734 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
735 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
736 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
737 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
738 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
739 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
740 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
741 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
742 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
743 * org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files
744
745 Interaction with other packages
746
747 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
748 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
749
750 Hacking
751
752 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
753 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
754 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
755 * Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends
756 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
757 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
758 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
759 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
760 * Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas
761 * Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information
762 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
763 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
764
765 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
766
767 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
768 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
769 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
770 * Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists
771
772 MobileOrg
773
774 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
775 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
776 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
777
778 @end detailmenu
779 @end menu
780
781 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
782 @chapter Introduction
783 @cindex introduction
784
785 @menu
786 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
787 * Installation:: Installing Org
788 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
789 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
790 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
791 @end menu
792
793 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
794 @section Summary
795 @cindex summary
796
797 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
798 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
799
800 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
801 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
802 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
803 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
804 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
805 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
806 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
807 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
808 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
809 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
810 For printing and sharing notes, an Org file can be exported as a
811 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
812 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
813 linked web pages.
814
815 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
816 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
817 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
818
819 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
820 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
821 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
822
823 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
824 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
825 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
826 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
827 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
828 the minor Orgstruct mode.
829
830 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
831 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
832 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
833 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
834 ends, for example:
835
836 @example
837 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
838 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
839 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
840 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
841 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
842 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
843 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
844 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked web pages}
845 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
846 @end example
847
848 @cindex FAQ
849 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
850 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
851 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
852 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
853
854 @cindex print edition
855 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
856 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
857 Theory Ltd.}
858
859 @page
860
861
862 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
863 @section Installation
864 @cindex installation
865 @cindex XEmacs
866
867 Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need
868 to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top
869 of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
870
871 @itemize @bullet
872 @item By using Emacs package system.
873 @item By downloading Org as an archive.
874 @item By using Org's git repository.
875 @end itemize
876
877 We @b{strongly recommend} to stick to a single installation method.
878
879 @subsubheading Using Emacs packaging system
880
881 Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install
882 Elisp libraries. You can install Org with @kbd{M-x package-install RET org}.
883 You need to do this in a session where no @code{.org} file has been visited.
884 Then, to make sure your Org configuration is taken into account, initialize
885 the package system with @code{(package-initialize)} in your @file{.emacs}
886 before setting any Org option. If you want to use Org's package repository,
887 check out the @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}.
888
889 @subsubheading Downloading Org as an archive
890
891 You can download Org latest release from @uref{http://orgmode.org/, Org's
892 website}. In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your
893 @file{.emacs}:
894
895 @lisp
896 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
897 @end lisp
898
899 The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included
900 in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @file{contrib} directory to your
901 load-path:
902
903 @lisp
904 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
905 @end lisp
906
907 Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system.
908 Run @code{make help} to list compilation and installation options.
909
910 @subsubheading Using Org's git repository
911
912 You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
913
914 @example
915 $ cd ~/src/
916 $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git
917 $ make autoloads
918 @end example
919
920 Note that in this case, @code{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's
921 version in @file{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in
922 @file{org-loaddefs.el}.
923
924 Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above.
925
926 You can also compile with @code{make}, generate the documentation with
927 @code{make doc}, create a local configuration with @code{make config} and
928 install Org with @code{make install}. Please run @code{make help} to get
929 the list of compilation/installation options.
930
931 For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org
932 Build System page on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html,
933 Worg}.
934
935 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
936 @section Activation
937 @cindex activation
938 @cindex autoload
939 @cindex ELPA
940 @cindex global key bindings
941 @cindex key bindings, global
942 @findex org-agenda
943 @findex org-capture
944 @findex org-store-link
945 @findex org-iswitchb
946
947 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
948 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
949 @file{.emacs} file:
950
951 @lisp
952 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
953 @end lisp
954
955 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
956 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
957 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
958
959 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
960 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
961
962 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
963 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
964 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
965 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
966 liking.
967 @lisp
968 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
969 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
970 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
971 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
972 @end lisp
973
974 @cindex Org mode, turning on
975 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
976 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
977 like this:
978
979 @example
980 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
981 @end example
982
983 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
984 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
985 the file's name is. See also the variable
986 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
987
988 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
989 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
990 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
991 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
992 @lisp
993 (transient-mark-mode 1)
994 @end lisp
995 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
996 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
997 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
998
999 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1000 @section Feedback
1001 @cindex feedback
1002 @cindex bug reports
1003 @cindex maintainer
1004 @cindex author
1005
1006 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1007 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1008 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1009 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1010 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1011 moderators have to do.}.
1012
1013 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1014 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1015 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1016 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1017 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1018 (@kbd{M-x org-version RET}), as well as the Org related setup in
1019 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1020 @example
1021 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report RET}
1022 @end example
1023 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1024 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1025 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1026
1027 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1028 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1029 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1030 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1031 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1032
1033 @example
1034 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1035 @end example
1036
1037 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1038 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1039 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1040 shown below.
1041
1042 @lisp
1043 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1044
1045 ;; activate debugging
1046 (setq debug-on-error t
1047 debug-on-signal nil
1048 debug-on-quit nil)
1049
1050 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1051 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1052 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1053 @end lisp
1054
1055 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1056 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1057 about:
1058
1059 @enumerate
1060 @item What exactly did you do?
1061 @item What did you expect to happen?
1062 @item What happened instead?
1063 @end enumerate
1064 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1065
1066 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1067
1068 @cindex backtrace of an error
1069 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1070 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1071 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1072 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1073 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1074
1075 @enumerate
1076 @item
1077 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1078 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1079 To do this, use
1080 @example
1081 @kbd{C-u M-x org-reload RET}
1082 @end example
1083 @noindent
1084 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1085 menu.
1086 @item
1087 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1088 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1089 @item
1090 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1091 document the steps you take.
1092 @item
1093 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1094 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1095 attach it to your bug report.
1096 @end enumerate
1097
1098 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1099 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1100
1101 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1102
1103 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1104 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1105
1106 @table @code
1107 @item TODO
1108 @itemx WAITING
1109 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1110 user-defined.
1111 @item boss
1112 @itemx ARCHIVE
1113 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1114 meaning are written with all capitals.
1115 @item Release
1116 @itemx PRIORITY
1117 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1118 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1119 @end table
1120
1121 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1122 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1123 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1124 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1125 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1126 @code{#+results}.}.
1127
1128 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1129 @kindex C-c a
1130 @findex org-agenda
1131 @kindex C-c c
1132 @findex org-capture
1133
1134 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1135 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1136 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1137
1138 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1139 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1140 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1141 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1142 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1143 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1144 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1145 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1146 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1147 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1148
1149 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1150 @chapter Document structure
1151 @cindex document structure
1152 @cindex structure of document
1153
1154 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1155 edit the structure of the document.
1156
1157 @menu
1158 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1159 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1160 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1161 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1162 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1163 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1164 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1165 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1166 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1167 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1168 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1169 * Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax
1170 @end menu
1171
1172 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1173 @section Outlines
1174 @cindex outlines
1175 @cindex Outline mode
1176
1177 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1178 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1179 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1180 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1181 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1182 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1183 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1184 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1185
1186 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1187 @section Headlines
1188 @cindex headlines
1189 @cindex outline tree
1190 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1191 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1192 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1193
1194 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1195 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1196 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1197 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1198 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1199 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1200
1201 @example
1202 * Top level headline
1203 ** Second level
1204 *** 3rd level
1205 some text
1206 *** 3rd level
1207 more text
1208
1209 * Another top level headline
1210 @end example
1211
1212 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1213 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1214 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1215
1216 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1217 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1218 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1219 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1220 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1221 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1222
1223 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1224 @section Visibility cycling
1225 @cindex cycling, visibility
1226 @cindex visibility cycling
1227 @cindex trees, visibility
1228 @cindex show hidden text
1229 @cindex hide text
1230
1231 @menu
1232 * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states
1233 * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state
1234 * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts
1235 @end menu
1236
1237 @node Global and local cycling, Initial visibility, Visibility cycling, Visibility cycling
1238 @subsection Global and local cycling
1239
1240 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1241 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1242 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1243
1244 @cindex subtree visibility states
1245 @cindex subtree cycling
1246 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1247 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1248 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1249 @table @asis
1250 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1251 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1252
1253 @example
1254 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1255 '-----------------------------------'
1256 @end example
1257
1258 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1259 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1260 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1261 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1262 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1263 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1264 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1265 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1266
1267 @cindex global visibility states
1268 @cindex global cycling
1269 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1270 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1271 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1272 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1273 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1274 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1275
1276 @example
1277 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1278 '--------------------------------------'
1279 @end example
1280
1281 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1282 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1283 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1284
1285 @cindex show all, command
1286 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1287 Show all, including drawers.
1288 @cindex revealing context
1289 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1290 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1291 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1292 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1293 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1294 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1295 entire subtree of the parent.
1296 @cindex show branches, command
1297 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1298 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1299 @cindex show children, command
1300 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1301 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1302 expose all children down to level N@.
1303 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1304 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1305 buffer
1306 @ifinfo
1307 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1308 @end ifinfo
1309 @ifnotinfo
1310 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1311 @end ifnotinfo
1312 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1313 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1314 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1315 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1316 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1317 the previously used indirect buffer.
1318 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1319 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1320 @end table
1321
1322 @menu
1323 * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state
1324 * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts
1325 @end menu
1326
1327 @node Initial visibility, Catching invisible edits, Global and local cycling, Visibility cycling
1328 @subsection Initial visibility
1329
1330 @cindex visibility, initialize
1331 @vindex org-startup-folded
1332 @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup
1333 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1334 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1335 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1336 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1337
1338 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to OVERVIEW,
1339 i.e., only the top level headlines are visible@footnote{When
1340 @code{org-agenda-inhibit-startup} is non-@code{nil}, Org will not honor the default
1341 visibility state when first opening a file for the agenda (@pxref{Speeding up
1342 your agendas}).} This can be configured through the variable
1343 @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a per-file basis by adding one of the
1344 following lines anywhere in the buffer:
1345
1346 @example
1347 #+STARTUP: overview
1348 #+STARTUP: content
1349 #+STARTUP: showall
1350 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1351 @end example
1352
1353 The startup visibility options are ignored when the file is open for the
1354 first time during the agenda generation: if you want the agenda to honor
1355 the startup visibility, set @code{org-agenda-inhibit-startup} to @code{nil}.
1356
1357 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1358 @noindent
1359 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1360 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1361 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1362 @code{all}.
1363
1364 @table @asis
1365 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1366 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1367 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1368 entries.
1369 @end table
1370
1371 @node Catching invisible edits, , Initial visibility, Visibility cycling
1372 @subsection Catching invisible edits
1373
1374 @vindex org-catch-invisible-edits
1375 @cindex edits, catching invisible
1376 Sometimes you may inadvertently edit an invisible part of the buffer and be
1377 confused on what has been edited and how to undo the mistake. Setting
1378 @code{org-catch-invisible-edits} to non-@code{nil} will help prevent this. See the
1379 docstring of this option on how Org should catch invisible edits and process
1380 them.
1381
1382 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1383 @section Motion
1384 @cindex motion, between headlines
1385 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1386 @cindex headline navigation
1387 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1388
1389 @table @asis
1390 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1391 Next heading.
1392 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1393 Previous heading.
1394 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1395 Next heading same level.
1396 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1397 Previous heading same level.
1398 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1399 Backward to higher level heading.
1400 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1401 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1402 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1403 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1404 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1405 @example
1406 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1407 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1408 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1409 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1410 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1411 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1412 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1413 u @r{One level up.}
1414 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1415 q @r{Quit}
1416 @end example
1417 @vindex org-goto-interface
1418 @noindent
1419 See also the option @code{org-goto-interface}.
1420 @end table
1421
1422 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1423 @section Structure editing
1424 @cindex structure editing
1425 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1426 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1427 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1428 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1429 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1430 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1431 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1432 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1433 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1434
1435 @table @asis
1436 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1437 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1438 Insert a new heading/item with the same level than the one at point.
1439 If the cursor is in a plain list item, a new item is created
1440 (@pxref{Plain lists}). To prevent this behavior in lists, call the
1441 command with a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1442 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1443 the new item or headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be
1444 split, customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If
1445 the command is used at the @emph{beginning} of a headline, the new
1446 headline is created before the current line. If the command is used
1447 at the @emph{end} of a folded subtree (i.e., behind the ellipses at
1448 the end of a headline), then a headline will be
1449 inserted after the end of the subtree. Calling this command with
1450 @kbd{C-u C-u} will unconditionally respect the headline's content and
1451 create a new item at the end of the parent subtree.
1452 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1453 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1454 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1455 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1456 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1457 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1458 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1459 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1460 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1461 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1462 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1463 subtree.
1464 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1465 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1466 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1467 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1468 to the initial level.
1469 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1470 Promote current heading by one level.
1471 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1472 Demote current heading by one level.
1473 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1474 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1475 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1476 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1477 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1478 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1479 level).
1480 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1481 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1482 @orgcmd{M-h,org-mark-element}
1483 Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements
1484 of the one just marked. E.g., hitting @key{M-h} on a paragraph will mark it,
1485 hitting @key{M-h} immediately again will mark the next one.
1486 @orgcmd{C-c @@,org-mark-subtree}
1487 Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees
1488 of the same level than the marked subtree.
1489 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1490 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1491 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1492 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1493 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1494 sequential subtrees.
1495 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1496 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1497 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1498 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1499 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1500 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1501 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1502 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1503 Depending on the options @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1504 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1505 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1506 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1507 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1508 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1509 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1510 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1511 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1512 folding.
1513 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1514 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1515 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1516 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1517 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1518 more details, see the docstring of the command
1519 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1520 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1521 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refile and copy}.
1522 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1523 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1524 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1525 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1526 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1527 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1528 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1529 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1530 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1531 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1532 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1533 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1534 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1535 Narrow buffer to current block.
1536 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1537 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1538 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1539 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1540 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1541 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1542 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1543 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1544 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1545 @end table
1546
1547 @cindex region, active
1548 @cindex active region
1549 @cindex transient mark mode
1550 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1551 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1552 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1553 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1554 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1555 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1556 functionality.
1557
1558
1559 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1560 @section Sparse trees
1561 @cindex sparse trees
1562 @cindex trees, sparse
1563 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1564 @cindex occur, command
1565
1566 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1567 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1568 @vindex org-show-siblings
1569 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1570 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1571 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1572 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1573 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1574 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1575 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1576 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1577 and you will see immediately how it works.
1578
1579 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1580 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1581
1582 @table @asis
1583 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1584 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1585 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1586 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1587 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1588 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1589 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1590 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1591 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1592 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1593 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1594 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1595 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1596 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1597 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1598 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1599 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1600 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1601 @end table
1602
1603 @noindent
1604 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1605 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1606 use the option @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1607 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1608 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1609 For example:
1610
1611 @lisp
1612 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1613 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1614 @end lisp
1615
1616 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1617 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1618
1619 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1620 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1621
1622 @kindex C-c C-e C-v
1623 @cindex printing sparse trees
1624 @cindex visible text, printing
1625 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1626 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1627 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1628 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1629 Or you can use @kbd{C-c C-e C-v} to export only the visible part of
1630 the document and print the resulting file.
1631
1632 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1633 @section Plain lists
1634 @cindex plain lists
1635 @cindex lists, plain
1636 @cindex lists, ordered
1637 @cindex ordered lists
1638
1639 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1640 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1641 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1642 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1643
1644 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1645 @itemize @bullet
1646 @item
1647 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1648 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1649 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1650 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1651 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1652 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1653 bullets.
1654 @item
1655 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1656 @vindex org-list-allow-alphabetical
1657 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1658 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1659 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1660 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1661 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-list-allow-alphabetical}. To minimize
1662 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1663 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1664 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1665 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1666 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1667 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1668 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1669 @item
1670 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1671 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1672 description.
1673 @end itemize
1674
1675 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1676 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1677 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1678 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1679 than its bullet/number.
1680
1681 @vindex org-list-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1682 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1683 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1684 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-list-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}.
1685 In that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1686
1687 @example
1688 @group
1689 ** Lord of the Rings
1690 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1691 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1692 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1693 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1694 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1695 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1696 - on DVD only
1697 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1698 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1699 Important actors in this film are:
1700 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1701 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1702 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1703 @end group
1704 @end example
1705
1706 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1707 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1708 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1709 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1710 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1711 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1712 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1713
1714 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1715 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1716 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1717 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1718 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1719 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1720 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1721
1722 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1723 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1724 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1725 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1726 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1727 to disable them individually.
1728
1729 @table @asis
1730 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1731 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1732 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1733 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1734 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1735 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1736 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1737 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1738 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1739 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1740 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1741 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1742 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1743 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1744 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1745 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1746 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1747 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1748 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1749 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1750 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1751 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1752 one.
1753 @end table
1754
1755 @table @kbd
1756 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1757 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1758 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1759 @kindex S-@key{down}
1760 @item S-up
1761 @itemx S-down
1762 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1763 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1764 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1765 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1766 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1767 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1768 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1769 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1770 similar effect.
1771 @kindex M-@key{up}
1772 @kindex M-@key{down}
1773 @item M-up
1774 @itemx M-down
1775 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1776 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1777 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1778 is automatic.
1779 @kindex M-@key{left}
1780 @kindex M-@key{right}
1781 @item M-left
1782 @itemx M-right
1783 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1784 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1785 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1786 @item M-S-@key{left}
1787 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1788 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1789 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1790 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1791 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1792 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1793 motion or so.
1794
1795 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1796 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1797 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1798 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1799 @kindex C-c C-c
1800 @item C-c C-c
1801 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1802 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1803 consistency in the whole list.
1804 @kindex C-c -
1805 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1806 @item C-c -
1807 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1808 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1809 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1810 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1811 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1812 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1813 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1814 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1815 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1816 @kindex C-c *
1817 @item C-c *
1818 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1819 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1820 @kindex C-c C-*
1821 @item C-c C-*
1822 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1823 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1824 (resp. checked).
1825 @kindex S-@key{left}
1826 @kindex S-@key{right}
1827 @item S-left/right
1828 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1829 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1830 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1831 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1832 @kindex C-c ^
1833 @cindex sorting, of plain list
1834 @item C-c ^
1835 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1836 numerically, alphabetically, by time, by checked status for check lists,
1837 or by a custom function.
1838 @end table
1839
1840 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1841 @section Drawers
1842 @cindex drawers
1843 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1844 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1845
1846 @vindex org-drawers
1847 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1848 @kindex C-c C-x d
1849 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1850 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1851 Drawers need to be configured with the option @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You
1852 can define additional drawers on a per-file basis with a line like
1853 @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers look like this:
1854
1855 @example
1856 ** This is a headline
1857 Still outside the drawer
1858 :DRAWERNAME:
1859 This is inside the drawer.
1860 :END:
1861 After the drawer.
1862 @end example
1863
1864 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1865 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1866 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1867 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1868 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1869 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1870
1871 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1872 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1873 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1874 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1875 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1876 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1877 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1878 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1879
1880 @table @kbd
1881 @kindex C-c C-z
1882 @item C-c C-z
1883 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1884 @end table
1885
1886 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
1887 You can select the name of the drawers which should be exported with
1888 @code{org-export-with-drawers}. In that case, drawer contents will appear in
1889 export output. Property drawers are not affected by this variable and are
1890 never exported.
1891
1892 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1893 @section Blocks
1894
1895 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1896 @cindex blocks, folding
1897 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1898 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1899 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1900 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1901 folded at startup by configuring the option @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1902 or on a per-file basis by using
1903
1904 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1905 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1906 @example
1907 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1908 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1909 @end example
1910
1911 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1912 @section Footnotes
1913 @cindex footnotes
1914
1915 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1916 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on
1917 a larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails.
1918
1919 A footnote is started by a footnote marker in square brackets in column 0, no
1920 indentation allowed. It ends at the next footnote definition, headline, or
1921 after two consecutive empty lines. The footnote reference is simply the
1922 marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1923
1924 @example
1925 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1926 ...
1927 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1928 @end example
1929
1930 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1931 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1932 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1933 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1934 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1935
1936 @table @code
1937 @item [1]
1938 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1939 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1940 snippet.
1941 @item [fn:name]
1942 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1943 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1944 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1945 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1946 reference point.
1947 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1948 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1949 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1950 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1951 @end table
1952
1953 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1954 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1955 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1956 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1957 for details.
1958
1959 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1960
1961 @table @kbd
1962 @kindex C-c C-x f
1963 @item C-c C-x f
1964 The footnote action command.
1965
1966 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1967 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1968
1969 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1970 @vindex org-footnote-section
1971 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1972 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the option
1973 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1974 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1975 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1976 separately into the location determined by the option
1977 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1978
1979 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1980 options is offered:
1981 @example
1982 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1983 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1984 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1985 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1986 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1987 @r{option @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1988 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1989 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the option}
1990 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1991 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1992 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1993 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1994 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1995 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1996 @r{off an email).}
1997 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1998 @r{to it.}
1999 @end example
2000 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
2001 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
2002 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
2003 deletion.
2004
2005 @kindex C-c C-c
2006 @item C-c C-c
2007 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
2008 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
2009 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
2010 @kindex C-c C-o
2011 @kindex mouse-1
2012 @kindex mouse-2
2013 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
2014 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
2015 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
2016 @end table
2017
2018 @node Orgstruct mode, Org syntax, Footnotes, Document Structure
2019 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
2020 @cindex Orgstruct mode
2021 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
2022
2023 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2024 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
2025 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
2026 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode RET}, or
2027 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2028
2029 @lisp
2030 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2031 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2032 @end lisp
2033
2034 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2035 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2036 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2037 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2038 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows.
2039
2040 When you use @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and
2041 autofill settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first
2042 line of an item.
2043
2044 @vindex orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp
2045 You can also use Org structure editing to fold and unfold headlines in
2046 @emph{any} file, provided you defined @code{orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp}:
2047 the regular expression must match the local prefix to use before Org's
2048 headlines. For example, if you set this variable to @code{";; "} in Emacs
2049 Lisp files, you will be able to fold and unfold headlines in Emacs Lisp
2050 commented lines. Some commands like @code{org-demote} are disabled when the
2051 prefix is set, but folding/unfolding will work correctly.
2052
2053 @node Org syntax, , Orgstruct mode, Document Structure
2054 @section Org syntax
2055 @cindex Org syntax
2056
2057 A reference document providing a formal description of Org's syntax is
2058 available as @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-syntax.html, a draft on
2059 Worg}, written and maintained by Nicolas Goaziou. It defines Org's core
2060 internal concepts such as @code{headlines}, @code{sections}, @code{affiliated
2061 keywords}, @code{(greater) elements} and @code{objects}. Each part of an Org
2062 file falls into one of the categories above.
2063
2064 To explore the abstract structure of an Org buffer, run this in a buffer:
2065
2066 @lisp
2067 M-: (org-element-parse-buffer) RET
2068 @end lisp
2069
2070 It will output a list containing the buffer's content represented as an
2071 abstract structure. The export engine relies on the information stored in
2072 this list. Most interactive commands (e.g., for structure editing) also
2073 rely on the syntactic meaning of the surrounding context.
2074
2075 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2076 @chapter Tables
2077 @cindex tables
2078 @cindex editing tables
2079
2080 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2081 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2082 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2083
2084 @menu
2085 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2086 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2087 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2088 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2089 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2090 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2091 @end menu
2092
2093 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2094 @section The built-in table editor
2095 @cindex table editor, built-in
2096
2097 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2098 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2099 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2100 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2101 might look like this:
2102
2103 @example
2104 | Name | Phone | Age |
2105 |-------+-------+-----|
2106 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2107 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2108 @end example
2109
2110 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2111 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2112 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2113 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2114 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2115 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2116 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2117 create the above table, you would only type
2118
2119 @example
2120 |Name|Phone|Age|
2121 |-
2122 @end example
2123
2124 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2125 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2126 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2127
2128 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2129 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2130 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2131 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2132 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2133 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2134 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2135 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2136 unpredictable for you, configure the options
2137 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2138
2139 @table @kbd
2140 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2141 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2142 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2143 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2144 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2145 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2146 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2147 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2148 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2149 @*
2150 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2151 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2152 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2153
2154 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2155 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2156 Re-align the table and don't move to another field.
2157 @c
2158 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2159 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2160 necessary.
2161 @c
2162 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2163 Re-align, move to previous field.
2164 @c
2165 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2166 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2167 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2168 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2169 @c
2170 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2171 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2172 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2173 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2174
2175 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2176 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2177 Move the current column left/right.
2178 @c
2179 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2180 Kill the current column.
2181 @c
2182 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2183 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2184 @c
2185 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2186 Move the current row up/down.
2187 @c
2188 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2189 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2190 @c
2191 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2192 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2193 created below the current one.
2194 @c
2195 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2196 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2197 is created above the current line.
2198 @c
2199 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2200 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2201 below that line.
2202 @c
2203 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2204 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2205 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2206 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2207 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2208 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2209 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2210 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2211 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2212 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2213
2214 @tsubheading{Regions}
2215 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2216 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2217 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2218 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2219 @c
2220 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2221 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2222 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2223 @c
2224 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2225 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2226 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2227 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2228 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2229 lines.
2230 @c
2231 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2232 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2233 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2234 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2235 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2236 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2237 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2238 above.
2239
2240 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2241 @cindex formula, in tables
2242 @cindex calculations, in tables
2243 @cindex region, active
2244 @cindex active region
2245 @cindex transient mark mode
2246 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2247 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2248 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2249 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2250 @c
2251 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2252 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2253 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2254 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2255 Depending on the option @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2256 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2257 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2258 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2259 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2260
2261 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2262 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2263 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2264 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2265 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2266 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2267 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2268 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2269 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2270 @c
2271 @item M-x org-table-import RET
2272 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2273 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2274 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2275 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2276 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2277 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2278 separator.
2279 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2280 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2281 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2282 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2283 @c
2284 @item M-x org-table-export RET
2285 @findex org-table-export
2286 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2287 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2288 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2289 used to export the file can be configured in the option
2290 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2291 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2292 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2293 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2294 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2295 detailed description.
2296 @end table
2297
2298 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2299 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2300 it off with
2301
2302 @lisp
2303 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2304 @end lisp
2305
2306 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2307 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2308
2309 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2310 @section Column width and alignment
2311 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2312 @cindex alignment in tables
2313
2314 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2315 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2316 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2317
2318 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2319 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2320 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2321 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2322 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2323 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2324 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2325
2326 @example
2327 @group
2328 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2329 | | | | | <6> |
2330 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2331 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2332 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2333 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2334 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2335 @end group
2336 @end example
2337
2338 @noindent
2339 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2340 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2341 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2342 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2343 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2344 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2345 C-c}.
2346
2347 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2348 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2349 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2350 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2351 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2352 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2353 on a per-file basis with:
2354
2355 @example
2356 #+STARTUP: align
2357 #+STARTUP: noalign
2358 @end example
2359
2360 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2361 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2362 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2363 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2364 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<r10>}.
2365
2366 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2367 automatically when exporting the document.
2368
2369 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2370 @section Column groups
2371 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2372
2373 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2374 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2375 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2376 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2377 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2378 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2379 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2380 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2381 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2382 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2383 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2384
2385 @example
2386 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2387 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2388 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2389 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2390 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2391 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2392 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2393 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2394 @end example
2395
2396 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2397 every vertical line you would like to have:
2398
2399 @example
2400 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2401 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2402 | / | < | | | < | |
2403 @end example
2404
2405 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2406 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2407 @cindex Orgtbl mode
2408 @cindex minor mode for tables
2409
2410 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2411 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2412 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2413 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode RET}. To turn it on by default, for
2414 example in Message mode, use
2415
2416 @lisp
2417 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2418 @end lisp
2419
2420 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2421 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2422 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2423 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2424 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2425
2426 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2427 @section The spreadsheet
2428 @cindex calculations, in tables
2429 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2430 @cindex @file{calc} package
2431
2432 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2433 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2434 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2435 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2436 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2437 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2438 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2439 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2440 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2441
2442 @menu
2443 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2444 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2445 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2446 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2447 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2448 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2449 * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables
2450 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2451 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2452 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2453 @end menu
2454
2455 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2456 @subsection References
2457 @cindex references
2458
2459 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2460 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2461 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2462 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2463 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2464
2465 @subsubheading Field references
2466 @cindex field references
2467 @cindex references, to fields
2468
2469 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2470 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2471 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2472 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2473 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2474 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2475 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the option
2476 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2477 representation that looks like this:
2478 @example
2479 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2480 @end example
2481
2482 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2483 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2484 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2485 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2486 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2487 column from the right.
2488
2489 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2490 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2491 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2492 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2493 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2494 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2495 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2496 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2497 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2498 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2499 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2500 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2501 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2502 after the third hline in the table.
2503
2504 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2505 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2506 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2507 implied.
2508
2509 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2510 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2511 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2512 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2513 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2514 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2515
2516 Here are a few examples:
2517
2518 @example
2519 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2520 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2521 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2522 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2523 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2524 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2525 @end example
2526
2527 @subsubheading Range references
2528 @cindex range references
2529 @cindex references, to ranges
2530
2531 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2532 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2533 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2534 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2535 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2536 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2537
2538 @example
2539 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2540 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2541 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2542 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2543 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left}
2544 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2545 @end example
2546
2547 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2548 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed,
2549 so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields. For other options
2550 with the mode switches @samp{E}, @samp{N} and examples @pxref{Formula syntax
2551 for Calc}.
2552
2553 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2554 @cindex field coordinates
2555 @cindex coordinates, of field
2556 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2557 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2558
2559 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2560 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2561 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2562 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2563
2564 @example
2565 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2566 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2567 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2568 @end example
2569
2570 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2571 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2572 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2573 number of rows.
2574
2575 @subsubheading Named references
2576 @cindex named references
2577 @cindex references, named
2578 @cindex name, of column or field
2579 @cindex constants, in calculations
2580 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2581
2582 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2583 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2584 constant. Constants are defined globally through the option
2585 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2586 line like
2587
2588 @example
2589 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2590 @end example
2591
2592 @noindent
2593 @vindex constants-unit-system
2594 @pindex constants.el
2595 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2596 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2597 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2598 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2599 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2600 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2601 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2602 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2603 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2604 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2605 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2606 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2607 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2608 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2609 numbers.
2610
2611 @subsubheading Remote references
2612 @cindex remote references
2613 @cindex references, remote
2614 @cindex references, to a different table
2615 @cindex name, of column or field
2616 @cindex constants, in calculations
2617 @cindex #+NAME, for table
2618
2619 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2620 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2621
2622 @example
2623 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2624 @end example
2625
2626 @noindent
2627 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2628 @code{#+NAME: Name} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2629 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2630 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2631 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2632 referenced table.
2633
2634 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2635 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2636 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2637 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2638
2639 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs @file{Calc}
2640 package. Note that @file{calc} has the non-standard convention that @samp{/}
2641 has lower precedence than @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as
2642 @samp{a/(b*c)}. Before evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc
2643 from Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc,
2644 GNU Emacs Calc Manual}), variable substitution takes place according to the
2645 rules described above.
2646 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2647 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2648 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2649
2650 @cindex format specifier
2651 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2652 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2653 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2654 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2655 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2656 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2657 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2658 compact. The default settings can be configured using the option
2659 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2660
2661 @noindent List of modes:
2662
2663 @table @asis
2664 @item @code{p20}
2665 Set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits.
2666 @item @code{n3}, @code{s3}, @code{e2}, @code{f4}
2667 Normal, scientific, engineering or fixed format of the result of Calc passed
2668 back to Org. Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as long as the Calc
2669 calculation precision is greater.
2670 @item @code{D}, @code{R}
2671 Degree and radian angle modes of Calc.
2672 @item @code{F}, @code{S}
2673 Fraction and symbolic modes of Calc.
2674 @item @code{T}, @code{t}
2675 Duration computations in Calc or Lisp, @pxref{Durations and time values}.
2676 @item @code{E}
2677 If and how to consider empty fields. Without @samp{E} empty fields in range
2678 references are suppressed so that the Calc vector or Lisp list contains only
2679 the non-empty fields. With @samp{E} the empty fields are kept. For empty
2680 fields in ranges or empty field references the value @samp{nan} (not a
2681 number) is used in Calc formulas and the empty string is used for Lisp
2682 formulas. Add @samp{N} to use 0 instead for both formula types. For the
2683 value of a field the mode @samp{N} has higher precedence than @samp{E}.
2684 @item @code{N}
2685 Interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers. See the next section
2686 to see how this is essential for computations with Lisp formulas. In Calc
2687 formulas it is used only occasionally because there number strings are
2688 already interpreted as numbers without @samp{N}.
2689 @item @code{L}
2690 Literal, for Lisp formulas only. See the next section.
2691 @end table
2692
2693 @noindent
2694 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation and
2695 -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2696 @samp{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2697 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2698 formatting@footnote{The @samp{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2699 because the value passed to it is converted into an @samp{integer} or
2700 @samp{double}. The @samp{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2701 signed value to 32 bits. The @samp{double} is limited in precision to 64
2702 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}. A
2703 few examples:
2704
2705 @example
2706 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2707 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2708 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2709 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2710 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2711 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2712 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2713 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2714 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2715 @end example
2716
2717 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations, (@pxref{Logical
2718 Operations, , Logical Operations, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}). For example
2719
2720 @table @code
2721 @item if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))
2722 "teen" if age $1 is less than 20, else the Org table result field is set to
2723 empty with the empty string.
2724 @item if("$1" == "nan" || "$2" == "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E
2725 Sum of the first two columns. When at least one of the input fields is empty
2726 the Org table result field is set to empty.
2727 @item if(typeof(vmean($1..$7)) == 12, string(""), vmean($1..$7); E
2728 Mean value of a range unless there is any empty field. Every field in the
2729 range that is empty is replaced by @samp{nan} which lets @samp{vmean} result
2730 in @samp{nan}. Then @samp{typeof == 12} detects the @samp{nan} from
2731 @samp{vmean} and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use this when
2732 the sample set is expected to never have missing values.
2733 @item if("$1..$7" == "[]", string(""), vmean($1..$7))
2734 Mean value of a range with empty fields skipped. Every field in the range
2735 that is empty is skipped. When all fields in the range are empty the mean
2736 value is not defined and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use
2737 this when the sample set can have a variable size.
2738 @item vmean($1..$7); EN
2739 To complete the example before: Mean value of a range with empty fields
2740 counting as samples with value 0. Use this only when incomplete sample sets
2741 should be padded with 0 to the full size.
2742 @end table
2743
2744 You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with @code{defmath}
2745 and use them in formula syntax for Calc.
2746
2747 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2748 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2749 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2750
2751 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2752 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2753 not enough.
2754
2755 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2756 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2757 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2758 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2759
2760 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2761 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2762 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2763 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2764 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2765 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2766 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2767 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2768 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2769 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2770
2771 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2772 computations in Lisp:
2773
2774 @table @code
2775 @item '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2776 Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1.
2777 @item '(+ $1 $2);N
2778 Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}.
2779 @item '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2780 Compute the sum of columns 1 to 4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}.
2781 @end table
2782
2783 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2784 @subsection Durations and time values
2785 @cindex Duration, computing
2786 @cindex Time, computing
2787 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2788
2789 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2790 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2791
2792 @example
2793 @group
2794 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2795 |---------+----------+----------|
2796 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2797 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2798 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2799 @end group
2800 @end example
2801
2802 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2803 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2804 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2805 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the option
2806 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2807 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2808 example above).
2809
2810 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2811 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2812
2813 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2814 @subsection Field and range formulas
2815 @cindex field formula
2816 @cindex range formula
2817 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2818 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2819
2820 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2821 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2822 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2823 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2824 current field will be replaced with the result.
2825
2826 @cindex #+TBLFM
2827 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2828 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2829 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2830 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2831 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2832 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2833 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2834 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2835 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2836 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2837 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2838
2839 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2840 command
2841
2842 @table @kbd
2843 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2844 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2845 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2846 it to the current field, and stores it.
2847 @end table
2848
2849 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2850 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2851 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2852 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2853 directly.
2854
2855 @table @code
2856 @item $2=
2857 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2858 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2859 @item @@3=
2860 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2861 the last row.
2862 @item @@1$2..@@4$3=
2863 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2864 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2865 @item $name=
2866 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2867 @end table
2868
2869 @node Column formulas, Lookup functions, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2870 @subsection Column formulas
2871 @cindex column formula
2872 @cindex formula, for table column
2873
2874 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2875 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2876 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2877 hlines with rows above and below, everything before the first such hline is
2878 considered part of the table @emph{header} and will not be modified by column
2879 formulas. Therefore a header is mandatory when you use column formulas and
2880 want to add hlines to group rows, like for example to separate a total row at
2881 the bottom from the summand rows above. (ii) Fields that already get a value
2882 from a field/range formula will be left alone by column formulas. These
2883 conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2884
2885 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2886 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2887 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2888 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2889 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2890 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2891 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2892 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2893 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2894 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2895
2896 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2897 following command:
2898
2899 @table @kbd
2900 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2901 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2902 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2903 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2904 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2905 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2906 @end table
2907
2908 @node Lookup functions, Editing and debugging formulas, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2909 @subsection Lookup functions
2910 @cindex lookup functions in tables
2911 @cindex table lookup functions
2912
2913 Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables.
2914 @table @code
2915 @item (org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2916 @findex org-lookup-first
2917 Searches for the first element @code{S} in list @code{S-LIST} for which
2918 @lisp
2919 (PREDICATE VAL S)
2920 @end lisp
2921 is @code{t}; returns the value from the corresponding position in list
2922 @code{R-LIST}. The default @code{PREDICATE} is @code{equal}. Note that the
2923 parameters @code{VAL} and @code{S} are passed to @code{PREDICATE} in the same
2924 order as the corresponding parameters are in the call to
2925 @code{org-lookup-first}, where @code{VAL} precedes @code{S-LIST}. If
2926 @code{R-LIST} is @code{nil}, the matching element @code{S} of @code{S-LIST}
2927 is returned.
2928 @item (org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2929 @findex org-lookup-last
2930 Similar to @code{org-lookup-first} above, but searches for the @i{last}
2931 element for which @code{PREDICATE} is @code{t}.
2932 @item (org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2933 @findex org-lookup-all
2934 Similar to @code{org-lookup-first}, but searches for @i{all} elements for
2935 which @code{PREDICATE} is @code{t}, and returns @i{all} corresponding
2936 values. This function can not be used by itself in a formula, because it
2937 returns a list of values. However, powerful lookups can be built when this
2938 function is combined with other Emacs Lisp functions.
2939 @end table
2940
2941 If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the @code{E} mode
2942 for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty fields will not be
2943 included in @code{S-LIST} and/or @code{R-LIST} which can, for example, result
2944 in an incorrect mapping from an element of @code{S-LIST} to the corresponding
2945 element of @code{R-LIST}.
2946
2947 These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays, count
2948 matching cells, rank results, group data etc. For practical examples
2949 see @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html, this
2950 tutorial on Worg}.
2951
2952 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Lookup functions, The spreadsheet
2953 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2954 @cindex formula editing
2955 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2956
2957 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2958 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the field.
2959 Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas of a table.
2960 When offering a formula for editing, Org converts references to the standard
2961 format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&}) if possible. If you prefer to only work
2962 with the internal format (like @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the
2963 option @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2964
2965 @table @kbd
2966 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2967 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2968 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2969 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2970 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2971 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2972 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2973 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2974 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2975 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2976 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2977 @kindex C-c @}
2978 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2979 @item C-c @}
2980 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2981 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2982 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2983 @kindex C-c @{
2984 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2985 @item C-c @{
2986 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2987 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2988 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2989 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2990 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2991 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2992 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2993 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2994 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2995
2996 @table @kbd
2997 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2998 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2999 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
3000 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
3001 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
3002 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
3003 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
3004 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
3005 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
3006 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
3007 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
3008 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
3009 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
3010 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
3011 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
3012 @kindex S-@key{up}
3013 @kindex S-@key{down}
3014 @kindex S-@key{left}
3015 @kindex S-@key{right}
3016 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
3017 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
3018 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
3019 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
3020 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
3021 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
3022 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
3023 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
3024 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
3025 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
3026 down.
3027 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
3028 Scroll the window displaying the table.
3029 @kindex C-c @}
3030 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
3031 @item C-c @}
3032 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
3033 @end table
3034 @end table
3035
3036 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
3037 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
3038 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
3039 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
3040 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
3041
3042 @kindex C-c C-c
3043 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
3044 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
3045 recalculation commands in the table.
3046
3047 @anchor{Using multiple #+TBLFM lines}
3048 @subsubheading Using multiple #+TBLFM lines
3049 @cindex #+TBLFM line, multiple
3050 @cindex #+TBLFM
3051 @cindex #+TBLFM, switching
3052 @kindex C-c C-c
3053
3054 You may apply the formula temporarily. This is useful when you
3055 switch the formula. Place multiple @samp{#+TBLFM} lines right
3056 after the table, and then press @kbd{C-c C-c} on the formula to
3057 apply. Here is an example:
3058
3059 @example
3060 | x | y |
3061 |---+---|
3062 | 1 | |
3063 | 2 | |
3064 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1
3065 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2
3066 @end example
3067
3068 @noindent
3069 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in the line of @samp{#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2} yields:
3070
3071 @example
3072 | x | y |
3073 |---+---|
3074 | 1 | 2 |
3075 | 2 | 4 |
3076 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1
3077 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2
3078 @end example
3079
3080 @noindent
3081 Note: If you recalculate this table (with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, for example), you
3082 will get the following result of applying only the first @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
3083
3084 @example
3085 | x | y |
3086 |---+---|
3087 | 1 | 1 |
3088 | 2 | 2 |
3089 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1
3090 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2
3091 @end example
3092
3093 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
3094 @cindex formula debugging
3095 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
3096 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
3097 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
3098 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
3099 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
3100 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
3101 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
3102
3103 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
3104 @subsection Updating the table
3105 @cindex recomputing table fields
3106 @cindex updating, table
3107
3108 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
3109 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
3110 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
3111
3112 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
3113 following commands:
3114
3115 @table @kbd
3116 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
3117 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
3118 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
3119 @c
3120 @kindex C-u C-c *
3121 @item C-u C-c *
3122 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
3123 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
3124 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
3125 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
3126 @c
3127 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
3128 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
3129 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
3130 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
3131 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables RET
3132 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
3133 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
3134 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables RET
3135 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
3136 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
3137 dependencies.
3138 @end table
3139
3140 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
3141 @subsection Advanced features
3142
3143 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
3144 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
3145 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
3146 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
3147 special marking characters.
3148
3149 @table @kbd
3150 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
3151 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
3152 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
3153 change all marks in the region.
3154 @end table
3155
3156 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
3157 makes use of these features:
3158
3159 @example
3160 @group
3161 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3162 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
3163 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3164 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
3165 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
3166 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
3167 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3168 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
3169 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
3170 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3171 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
3172 | ^ | | | | | at | |
3173 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
3174 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3175 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
3176 @end group
3177 @end example
3178
3179 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
3180 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
3181 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3182 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3183 empty first field.
3184
3185 @cindex marking characters, tables
3186 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3187
3188 @table @samp
3189 @item !
3190 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3191 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3192 @item ^
3193 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3194 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3195 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3196 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3197 @item _
3198 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3199 @emph{below}.
3200 @item $
3201 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3202 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3203 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3204 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3205 a per-table basis.
3206 @item #
3207 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3208 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3209 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3210 lines will be left alone by this command.
3211 @item *
3212 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3213 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3214 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3215 @item @w{ }
3216 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3217 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3218 or @samp{*}.
3219 @item /
3220 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3221 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3222 @end table
3223
3224 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3225 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3226 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3227 functions.
3228
3229 @example
3230 @group
3231 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3232 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3233 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3234 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3235 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3236 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3237 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3238 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3239 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3240 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3241 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3242 @end group
3243 @end example
3244
3245 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3246 @section Org-Plot
3247 @cindex graph, in tables
3248 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3249 @cindex #+PLOT
3250
3251 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3252 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3253 @uref{http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode}. To see this in action, ensure
3254 that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then
3255 call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3256
3257 @example
3258 @group
3259 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3260 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3261 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3262 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3263 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3264 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3265 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3266 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3267 @end group
3268 @end example
3269
3270 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3271 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3272 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3273 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3274 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3275 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3276
3277 @subsubheading Plot Options
3278
3279 @table @code
3280 @item set
3281 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3282
3283 @item title
3284 Specify the title of the plot.
3285
3286 @item ind
3287 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3288
3289 @item deps
3290 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3291 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3292 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3293 column).
3294
3295 @item type
3296 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3297
3298 @item with
3299 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3300 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3301 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3302
3303 @item file
3304 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3305
3306 @item labels
3307 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3308 if they exist).
3309
3310 @item line
3311 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3312
3313 @item map
3314 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3315 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3316
3317 @item timefmt
3318 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3319 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3320
3321 @item script
3322 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3323 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3324 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3325 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3326 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3327 the data file.
3328 @end table
3329
3330 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3331 @chapter Hyperlinks
3332 @cindex hyperlinks
3333
3334 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3335 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3336
3337 @menu
3338 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3339 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3340 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3341 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3342 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3343 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3344 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3345 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3346 @end menu
3347
3348 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3349 @section Link format
3350 @cindex link format
3351 @cindex format, of links
3352
3353 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3354 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3355
3356 @example
3357 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3358 @end example
3359
3360 @noindent
3361 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3362 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3363 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3364 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3365 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3366 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3367 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3368 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3369 cursor on the link.
3370
3371 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3372 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3373 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3374 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3375 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3376 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3377 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3378
3379 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3380 @section Internal links
3381 @cindex internal links
3382 @cindex links, internal
3383 @cindex targets, for links
3384
3385 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3386 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3387 current file. The most important case is a link like
3388 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3389 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. You are responsible yourself
3390 to make sure these custom IDs are unique in a file.
3391
3392 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3393 lead to a text search in the current file.
3394
3395 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3396 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3397 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3398 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets, like
3399 @samp{<<My Target>>}.
3400
3401 @cindex #+NAME
3402 If no dedicated target exists, the link will then try to match the exact name
3403 of an element within the buffer. Naming is done with the @code{#+NAME}
3404 keyword, which has to be put the line before the element it refers to, as in
3405 the following example
3406
3407 @example
3408 #+NAME: My Target
3409 | a | table |
3410 |----+------------|
3411 | of | four cells |
3412 @end example
3413
3414 If none of the above succeeds, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3415 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3416 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type
3417 a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3418 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3419 completions.}.
3420
3421 During export, internal links will be used to mark objects and assign them
3422 a number. Marked objects will then be referenced by links pointing to them.
3423 In particular, links without a description will appear as the number assigned
3424 to the marked object@footnote{When targeting a @code{#+NAME} keyword,
3425 @code{#+CAPTION} keyword is mandatory in order to get proper numbering
3426 (@pxref{Images and tables}).}. In the following excerpt from an Org buffer
3427
3428 @example
3429 - one item
3430 - <<target>>another item
3431 Here we refer to item [[target]].
3432 @end example
3433
3434 @noindent
3435 The last sentence will appear as @samp{Here we refer to item 2} when
3436 exported.
3437
3438 In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the link text. In
3439 the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3440
3441 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3442 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3443 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3444 earlier.
3445
3446 @menu
3447 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3448 @end menu
3449
3450 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3451 @subsection Radio targets
3452 @cindex radio targets
3453 @cindex targets, radio
3454 @cindex links, radio targets
3455
3456 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3457 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3458 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3459 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3460 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3461 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3462 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3463 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3464 cursor on or at a target.
3465
3466 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3467 @section External links
3468 @cindex links, external
3469 @cindex external links
3470 @cindex Gnus links
3471 @cindex BBDB links
3472 @cindex IRC links
3473 @cindex URL links
3474 @cindex file links
3475 @cindex RMAIL links
3476 @cindex MH-E links
3477 @cindex USENET links
3478 @cindex SHELL links
3479 @cindex Info links
3480 @cindex Elisp links
3481
3482 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB
3483 database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs.
3484 External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short identifying
3485 string followed by a colon. There can be no space after the colon. The
3486 following list shows examples for each link type.
3487
3488 @example
3489 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3490 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3491 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3492 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3493 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3494 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3495 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3496 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3497 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3498 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3499 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3500 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3501 the option @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3502 is @code{nil}, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3503 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3504 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3505 will be queried to create it.}
3506 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3507 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3508 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3509 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3510 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3511 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3512 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3513 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3514 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3515 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3516 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3517 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3518 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3519 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3520 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3521 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3522 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3523 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3524 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3525 @end example
3526
3527 @cindex VM links
3528 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3529 On top of these built-in link types, some are available through the
3530 @code{contrib/} directory (@pxref{Installation}). For example, these links
3531 to VM or Wanderlust messages are available when you load the corresponding
3532 libraries from the @code{contrib/} directory:
3533
3534 @example
3535 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3536 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3537 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3538 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3539 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3540 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3541 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3542 @end example
3543
3544 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3545
3546 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a descriptive
3547 text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link format}), for example:
3548
3549 @example
3550 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3551 @end example
3552
3553 @noindent
3554 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3555 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3556 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3557 image,
3558 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3559
3560 @cindex square brackets, around links
3561 @cindex plain text external links
3562 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3563 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3564 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3565 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3566
3567 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3568 @section Handling links
3569 @cindex links, handling
3570
3571 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3572 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3573
3574 @table @kbd
3575 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3576 @cindex storing links
3577 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3578 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3579 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3580 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3581 buffer:
3582
3583 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3584 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3585 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3586 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3587 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3588 timestamp in the headline.}.
3589
3590 @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id
3591 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3592 @cindex property, ID
3593 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3594 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3595 @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will
3596 be created and/or used to construct a link@footnote{The library
3597 @file{org-id.el} must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize} by
3598 enabling @code{org-id} in @code{org-modules}, or by adding @code{(require
3599 'org-id)} in your @file{.emacs}.}. So using this command in Org buffers will
3600 potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom ID, and one
3601 that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from file to
3602 file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one to use.
3603
3604 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3605 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3606 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3607 constructed from the author and the subject.
3608
3609 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3610 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3611
3612 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3613 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3614
3615 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
3616 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3617 For IRC links, if you set the option @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to @code{t},
3618 a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current
3619 conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to the
3620 user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3621
3622 @b{Other files}@*
3623 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3624 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3625 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3626 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3627 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3628 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3629 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3630
3631 @b{Agenda view}@*
3632 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3633 entry referenced by the current line.
3634
3635 @c
3636 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3637 @cindex link completion
3638 @cindex completion, of links
3639 @cindex inserting links
3640 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3641 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3642 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3643 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3644 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3645 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3646 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3647 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3648 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3649 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3650 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3651 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3652 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3653 becomes the default description.
3654
3655 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3656 All links stored during the
3657 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3658 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3659
3660 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3661 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3662 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3663 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3664 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3665 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3666 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3667 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3668 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3669 @orgkey C-u C-c C-l
3670 @cindex file name completion
3671 @cindex completion, of file names
3672 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3673 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3674 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3675 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3676 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3677 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3678 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3679 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3680 @c
3681 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3682 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3683 link and description parts of the link.
3684 @c
3685 @cindex following links
3686 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3687 @vindex org-file-apps
3688 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3689 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3690 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3691 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3692 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3693 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3694 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3695 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3696 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3697 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3698 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3699 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3700 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3701 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3702 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3703 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3704
3705 @orgkey @key{RET}
3706 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3707 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3708 the link at point.
3709 @c
3710 @kindex mouse-2
3711 @kindex mouse-1
3712 @item mouse-2
3713 @itemx mouse-1
3714 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3715 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3716 @c
3717 @kindex mouse-3
3718 @item mouse-3
3719 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3720 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3721 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3722 option @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3723 @c
3724 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3725 @cindex inlining images
3726 @cindex images, inlining
3727 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3728 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3729 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3730 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3731 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3732 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3733 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3734 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3735 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3736 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{noinlineimages}}.
3737 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3738 @cindex mark ring
3739 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3740 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3741 @c
3742 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3743 @cindex links, returning to
3744 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3745 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3746 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3747 previously recorded positions.
3748 @c
3749 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3750 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3751 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3752 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3753 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3754 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3755 @lisp
3756 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3757 (lambda ()
3758 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3759 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3760 @end lisp
3761 @end table
3762
3763 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3764 @section Using links outside Org
3765
3766 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3767 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3768 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3769 yourself):
3770
3771 @lisp
3772 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3773 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3774 @end lisp
3775
3776 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3777 @section Link abbreviations
3778 @cindex link abbreviations
3779 @cindex abbreviation, links
3780
3781 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3782 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3783 abbreviated link looks like this
3784
3785 @example
3786 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3787 @end example
3788
3789 @noindent
3790 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3791 where the tag is optional.
3792 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3793 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3794 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3795 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3796
3797 @smalllisp
3798 @group
3799 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3800 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3801 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3802 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3803 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3804 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3805 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3806 @end group
3807 @end smalllisp
3808
3809 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3810 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3811 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3812 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3813 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3814
3815 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3816 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3817
3818 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3819 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3820
3821 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3822 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3823 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3824 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3825 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3826 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3827 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3828
3829 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3830 can define them in the file with
3831
3832 @cindex #+LINK
3833 @example
3834 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3835 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3836 @end example
3837
3838 @noindent
3839 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3840 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3841 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3842 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3843 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3844
3845 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3846 @section Search options in file links
3847 @cindex search option in file links
3848 @cindex file links, searching
3849
3850 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3851 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3852 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3853 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3854 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3855 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3856 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3857 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3858
3859 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3860 link, together with an explanation:
3861
3862 @example
3863 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3864 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3865 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3866 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3867 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3868 @end example
3869
3870 @table @code
3871 @item 255
3872 Jump to line 255.
3873 @item My Target
3874 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3875 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3876 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3877 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3878 the linked file.
3879 @item *My Target
3880 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3881 @item #my-custom-id
3882 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3883 @item /regexp/
3884 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3885 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3886 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3887 sparse tree with the matches.
3888 @c If the target file is a directory,
3889 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3890 @end table
3891
3892 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3893 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3894 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3895 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3896
3897 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3898 @section Custom Searches
3899 @cindex custom search strings
3900 @cindex search strings, custom
3901
3902 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3903 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3904 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3905 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3906 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3907 citation key.
3908
3909 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3910 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3911 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3912 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3913 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3914 to be added to the hook variables
3915 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3916 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3917 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3918 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3919 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3920
3921 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3922 @chapter TODO items
3923 @cindex TODO items
3924
3925 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3926 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3927 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3928 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3929 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3930 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3931 item emerged is always present.
3932
3933 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3934 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3935 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3936
3937 @menu
3938 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3939 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3940 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3941 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3942 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3943 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3944 @end menu
3945
3946 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3947 @section Basic TODO functionality
3948
3949 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3950 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3951
3952 @example
3953 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3954 @end example
3955
3956 @noindent
3957 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3958
3959 @table @kbd
3960 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3961 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3962 @vindex org-use-fast-todo-selection
3963
3964 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3965
3966 @example
3967 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3968 '--------------------------------'
3969 @end example
3970
3971 If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO
3972 states}), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection
3973 interface; this is the default behavior when
3974 @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is non-@code{nil}.
3975
3976 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and agenda
3977 buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3978
3979 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3980 When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using
3981 completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When
3982 @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is set to @code{prefix}, use the fast
3983 selection interface.
3984
3985 @kindex S-@key{right}
3986 @kindex S-@key{left}
3987 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3988 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3989 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3990 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3991 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3992 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3993 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3994 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3995 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3996 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3997 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3998 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3999 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
4000 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword,
4001 and you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
4002 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
4003 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the option @code{org-todo-keywords}.
4004 With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states, both un-done and done.
4005 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
4006 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
4007 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
4008 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
4009 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4010 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
4011 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4012 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
4013 @end table
4014
4015 @noindent
4016 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
4017 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
4018 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
4019
4020 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
4021 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
4022 @cindex extended TODO keywords
4023
4024 @vindex org-todo-keywords
4025 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
4026 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
4027 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
4028 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
4029 files.
4030
4031 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
4032 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
4033
4034 @menu
4035 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
4036 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
4037 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
4038 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
4039 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
4040 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
4041 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
4042 @end menu
4043
4044 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
4045 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
4046 @cindex TODO workflow
4047 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
4048
4049 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
4050 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
4051 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
4052 buffer.}:
4053
4054 @lisp
4055 (setq org-todo-keywords
4056 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
4057 @end lisp
4058
4059 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
4060 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
4061 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
4062 state.
4063 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
4064 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
4065 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
4066 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
4067 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
4068 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
4069 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
4070 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
4071 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
4072 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
4073 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
4074
4075 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
4076 @subsection TODO keywords as types
4077 @cindex TODO types
4078 @cindex names as TODO keywords
4079 @cindex types as TODO keywords
4080
4081 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
4082 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
4083 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
4084 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
4085 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
4086 be set up like this:
4087
4088 @lisp
4089 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
4090 @end lisp
4091
4092 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
4093 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
4094 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
4095 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
4096 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
4097 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
4098 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
4099 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
4100 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
4101 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
4102 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
4103 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
4104 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
4105 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
4106
4107 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
4108 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
4109 @cindex TODO keyword sets
4110
4111 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
4112 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
4113 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
4114 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
4115 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
4116 like this:
4117
4118 @lisp
4119 (setq org-todo-keywords
4120 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
4121 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
4122 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
4123 @end lisp
4124
4125 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
4126 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
4127 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
4128 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
4129 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
4130 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
4131 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
4132
4133 @table @kbd
4134 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
4135 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
4136 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
4137 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
4138 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
4139 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
4140 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
4141 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
4142 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
4143 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
4144 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4145 @kindex S-@key{right}
4146 @kindex S-@key{left}
4147 @item S-@key{right}
4148 @itemx S-@key{left}
4149 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
4150 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
4151 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
4152 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4153 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4154 @end table
4155
4156 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
4157 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
4158
4159 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
4160 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
4161 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
4162 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
4163 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
4164
4165 @lisp
4166 (setq org-todo-keywords
4167 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
4168 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
4169 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
4170 @end lisp
4171
4172 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
4173 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
4174 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
4175 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the option
4176 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
4177 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
4178 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
4179 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
4180
4181 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
4182 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
4183 @cindex keyword options
4184 @cindex per-file keywords
4185 @cindex #+TODO
4186 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
4187 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
4188
4189 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
4190 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
4191 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
4192 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
4193 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
4194 file:
4195
4196 @example
4197 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
4198 @end example
4199 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
4200 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
4201 @example
4202 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
4203 @end example
4204
4205 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
4206
4207 @example
4208 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
4209 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
4210 #+TODO: | CANCELED
4211 @end example
4212
4213 @cindex completion, of option keywords
4214 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4215 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4216 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4217
4218 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4219 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4220 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4221 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4222 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4223 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4224 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4225 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4226 for the current buffer.}.
4227
4228 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4229 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4230 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4231
4232 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4233 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4234 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4235 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4236 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4237 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4238 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4239 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the option
4240 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4241
4242 @lisp
4243 @group
4244 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4245 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4246 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4247 @end group
4248 @end lisp
4249
4250 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4251 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4252 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The option
4253 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4254 foreground or a background color.
4255
4256 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4257 @subsection TODO dependencies
4258 @cindex TODO dependencies
4259 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4260
4261 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4262 @cindex property, ORDERED
4263 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4264 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4265 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4266 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4267 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4268 the option @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4269 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4270 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4271 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4272 example:
4273
4274 @example
4275 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4276 ** DONE one
4277 ** TODO two
4278
4279 * Parent
4280 :PROPERTIES:
4281 :ORDERED: t
4282 :END:
4283 ** TODO a
4284 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4285 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4286 @end example
4287
4288 @table @kbd
4289 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4290 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4291 @cindex property, ORDERED
4292 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4293 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4294 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4295 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the option
4296 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4297 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4298 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4299 @end table
4300
4301 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4302 If you set the option @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4303 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4304 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4305
4306 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4307 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4308 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4309 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the option
4310 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4311 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4312
4313 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4314 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4315 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4316
4317 @page
4318 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4319 @section Progress logging
4320 @cindex progress logging
4321 @cindex logging, of progress
4322
4323 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4324 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4325 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a
4326 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4327 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4328 work time}.
4329
4330 @menu
4331 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4332 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4333 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4334 @end menu
4335
4336 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4337 @subsection Closing items
4338
4339 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4340 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4341 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4342
4343 @lisp
4344 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4345 @end lisp
4346
4347 @vindex org-closed-keep-when-no-todo
4348 @noindent
4349 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any of the
4350 DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted just after
4351 the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item through further
4352 state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you turn the entry back
4353 to a non-TODO state (by pressing @key{C-c C-t SPC} for example), that line
4354 will also be removed, unless you set @code{org-closed-keep-when-no-todo} to
4355 non-@code{nil}. If you want to record a note along with the timestamp,
4356 use@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP:
4357 lognotedone}.}
4358
4359 @lisp
4360 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4361 @end lisp
4362
4363 @noindent
4364 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4365 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4366
4367 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4368 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4369 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4370 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4371
4372 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4373 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4374 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4375
4376 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4377 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4378 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4379 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4380 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4381 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4382 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4383 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the option
4384 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4385 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4386 Customize @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the recommended
4387 drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4388 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4389 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4390 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4391 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4392
4393 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4394 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4395 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4396 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4397 setting
4398
4399 @lisp
4400 (setq org-todo-keywords
4401 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4402 @end lisp
4403
4404 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4405 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4406
4407 @noindent
4408 @vindex org-log-done
4409 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4410 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4411 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4412 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4413 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4414 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4415 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4416 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4417 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4418 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4419 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4420 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4421 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4422 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4423 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4424 configured.
4425
4426 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4427 to a buffer:
4428 @example
4429 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4430 @end example
4431
4432 @cindex property, LOGGING
4433 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4434 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4435 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to @code{nil}. You may then turn
4436 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4437 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4438 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4439
4440 @example
4441 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4442 :PROPERTIES:
4443 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4444 :END:
4445 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4446 :PROPERTIES:
4447 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4448 :END:
4449 * TODO No logging at all
4450 :PROPERTIES:
4451 :LOGGING: nil
4452 :END:
4453 @end example
4454
4455 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4456 @subsection Tracking your habits
4457 @cindex habits
4458
4459 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4460 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4461
4462 @enumerate
4463 @item
4464 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing @code{org-modules}.
4465 @item
4466 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4467 @item
4468 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4469 @item
4470 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4471 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4472 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4473 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4474 @item
4475 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4476 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4477 three days, but at most every two days.
4478 @item
4479 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4480 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4481 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4482 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4483 @end enumerate
4484
4485 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4486 actual habit with some history:
4487
4488 @example
4489 ** TODO Shave
4490 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4491 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4492 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4493 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4494 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4495 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4496 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4497 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4498 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4499 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4500 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4501 :PROPERTIES:
4502 :STYLE: habit
4503 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4504 :END:
4505 @end example
4506
4507 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4508 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4509 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4510 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4511 after four days have elapsed.
4512
4513 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4514 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4515 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4516 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4517
4518 @table @code
4519 @item Blue
4520 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4521 @item Green
4522 If the task could have been done on that day.
4523 @item Yellow
4524 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4525 @item Red
4526 If the task was overdue on that day.
4527 @end table
4528
4529 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4530 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4531 the current day falls in the graph.
4532
4533 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4534 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4535
4536 @table @code
4537 @item org-habit-graph-column
4538 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4539 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4540 titles brief and to the point.
4541 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4542 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4543 @item org-habit-following-days
4544 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4545 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4546 If non-@code{nil}, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4547 default.
4548 @end table
4549
4550 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4551 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4552 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4553 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4554
4555 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4556 @section Priorities
4557 @cindex priorities
4558
4559 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4560 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4561 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4562
4563 @example
4564 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4565 @end example
4566
4567 @noindent
4568 @vindex org-priority-faces
4569 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4570 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4571 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4572 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4573 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4574 special faces by customizing @code{org-priority-faces}.
4575
4576 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4577 items.
4578
4579 @table @kbd
4580 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
4581 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
4582 @findex org-priority
4583 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4584 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4585 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4586 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4587 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4588 @c
4589 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4590 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4591 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4592 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4593 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4594 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4595 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4596 @end table
4597
4598 @vindex org-highest-priority
4599 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4600 @vindex org-default-priority
4601 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the options
4602 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4603 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4604 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4605 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4606 priority):
4607
4608 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4609 @example
4610 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
4611 @end example
4612
4613 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4614 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4615 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4616 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4617
4618 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4619 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4620 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4621 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4622 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4623 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4624 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4625 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4626 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4627
4628 @example
4629 * Organize Party [33%]
4630 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4631 *** TODO Peter
4632 *** DONE Sarah
4633 ** TODO Buy food
4634 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4635 @end example
4636
4637 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4638 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4639 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4640 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4641 this issue.
4642
4643 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4644 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4645 subtree (not just direct children), configure
4646 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4647 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4648 property.
4649
4650 @example
4651 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4652 :PROPERTIES:
4653 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4654 :END:
4655 @end example
4656
4657 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4658 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4659
4660 @example
4661 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4662 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4663 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4664 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4665
4666 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4667 @end example
4668
4669
4670 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4671 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4672
4673
4674 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4675 @section Checkboxes
4676 @cindex checkboxes
4677
4678 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4679 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4680 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4681 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4682 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4683 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4684 in the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4685 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4686 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4687 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4688
4689 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4690
4691 @example
4692 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4693 - [-] call people [1/3]
4694 - [ ] Peter
4695 - [X] Sarah
4696 - [ ] Sam
4697 - [X] order food
4698 - [ ] think about what music to play
4699 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4700 @end example
4701
4702 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4703 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4704 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4705 checked.
4706
4707 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4708 @cindex checkbox statistics
4709 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4710 @vindex org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics
4711 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4712 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4713 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4714 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4715 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4716 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4717 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the option
4718 @code{org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4719 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4720 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4721 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4722 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4723 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4724 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4725 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4726 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4727 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4728
4729 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4730 @cindex checkbox blocking
4731 @cindex property, ORDERED
4732 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4733 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4734 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4735
4736 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4737
4738 @table @kbd
4739 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4740 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4741 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4742 one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4743 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4744 considered to be an intermediate state.
4745 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4746 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4747 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4748 intermediate state.
4749 @itemize @minus
4750 @item
4751 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4752 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4753 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4754 @item
4755 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4756 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4757 @item
4758 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4759 @end itemize
4760 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4761 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4762 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4763 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4764 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4765 @cindex property, ORDERED
4766 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4767 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4768 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4769 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4770 for better visibility, customize @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4771 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4772 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4773 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4774 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4775 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4776 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4777 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4778 @end table
4779
4780 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4781 @chapter Tags
4782 @cindex tags
4783 @cindex headline tagging
4784 @cindex matching, tags
4785 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4786
4787 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4788 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4789 support for tags.
4790
4791 @vindex org-tag-faces
4792 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4793 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4794 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4795 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4796 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4797 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the option
4798 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4799 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4800
4801 @menu
4802 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4803 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4804 * Tag groups:: Use one tag to search for several tags
4805 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4806 @end menu
4807
4808 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4809 @section Tag inheritance
4810 @cindex tag inheritance
4811 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4812 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4813
4814 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4815 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4816 well. For example, in the list
4817
4818 @example
4819 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4820 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4821 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4822 @end example
4823
4824 @noindent
4825 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4826 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4827 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4828 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4829 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4830 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4831 changes in the line.}:
4832
4833 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4834 @example
4835 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4836 @end example
4837
4838 @noindent
4839 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4840 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4841 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4842 To turn it off entirely, use @code{org-use-tag-inheritance}.
4843
4844 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4845 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4846 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4847 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4848 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4849 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4850 match in a subtree, configure @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not
4851 recommended).
4852
4853 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
4854 Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag,
4855 either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda
4856 types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to
4857 have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine,
4858 with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control
4859 this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to @code{nil}
4860 can really speed up agenda generation.
4861
4862 @node Setting tags, Tag groups, Tag inheritance, Tags
4863 @section Setting tags
4864 @cindex setting tags
4865 @cindex tags, setting
4866
4867 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4868 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4869 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4870 also a special command for inserting tags:
4871
4872 @table @kbd
4873 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4874 @cindex completion, of tags
4875 @vindex org-tags-column
4876 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4877 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4878 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4879 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4880 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4881 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4882 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4883
4884 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4885 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4886 @end table
4887
4888 @vindex org-tag-alist
4889 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4890 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4891 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4892 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4893 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4894
4895 @cindex #+TAGS
4896 @example
4897 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4898 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4899 @end example
4900
4901 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4902 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4903 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4904
4905 @example
4906 #+TAGS:
4907 @end example
4908
4909 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4910 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4911 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4912 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4913 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4914 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4915
4916 @example
4917 #+STARTUP: noptag
4918 @end example
4919
4920 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4921 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4922 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4923 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4924 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4925 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4926 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4927 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4928 like:
4929
4930 @lisp
4931 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4932 @end lisp
4933
4934 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4935 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4936
4937 @example
4938 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4939 @end example
4940
4941 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4942 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4943 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4944
4945 @example
4946 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4947 @end example
4948
4949 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4950
4951 @example
4952 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4953 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4954 @end example
4955
4956 @noindent
4957 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4958 braces, as in:
4959
4960 @example
4961 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4962 @end example
4963
4964 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4965 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4966
4967 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4968 these lines to activate any changes.
4969
4970 @noindent
4971 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tag-alist},
4972 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4973 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4974 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4975 configuration:
4976
4977 @lisp
4978 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4979 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4980 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4981 (:endgroup . nil)
4982 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4983 @end lisp
4984
4985 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4986 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4987 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4988 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4989 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4990 keys:
4991
4992 @table @kbd
4993 @item a-z...
4994 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4995 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4996 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4997 @kindex @key{TAB}
4998 @item @key{TAB}
4999 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
5000 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
5001 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
5002
5003 @kindex @key{SPC}
5004 @item @key{SPC}
5005 Clear all tags for this line.
5006 @kindex @key{RET}
5007 @item @key{RET}
5008 Accept the modified set.
5009 @item C-g
5010 Abort without installing changes.
5011 @item q
5012 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
5013 @item !
5014 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
5015 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
5016 @item C-c
5017 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
5018 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
5019 selection window.
5020 @end table
5021
5022 @noindent
5023 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
5024 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
5025 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
5026 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
5027 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
5028 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
5029 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
5030 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
5031
5032 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
5033 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
5034 modify your list of tags, set @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}.
5035 Then you no longer have to press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it
5036 will immediately exit after the first change. If you then occasionally
5037 need more keys, press @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag
5038 selection process (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c}
5039 instead of @kbd{C-c C-c}). If you set the variable to the value
5040 @code{expert}, the special window is not even shown for single-key tag
5041 selection, it comes up only when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
5042
5043 @node Tag groups, Tag searches, Setting tags, Tags
5044 @section Tag groups
5045
5046 @cindex group tags
5047 @cindex tags, groups
5048 In a set of mutually exclusive tags, the first tag can be defined as a
5049 @emph{group tag}. When you search for a group tag, it will return matches
5050 for all members in the group. In an agenda view, filtering by a group tag
5051 will display headlines tagged with at least one of the members of the
5052 group. This makes tag searches and filters even more flexible.
5053
5054 You can set group tags by inserting a colon between the group tag and other
5055 tags---beware that all whitespaces are mandatory so that Org can parse this
5056 line correctly:
5057
5058 @example
5059 #+TAGS: @{ @@read : @@read_book @@read_ebook @}
5060 @end example
5061
5062 In this example, @samp{@@read} is a @emph{group tag} for a set of three
5063 tags: @samp{@@read}, @samp{@@read_book} and @samp{@@read_ebook}.
5064
5065 You can also use the @code{:grouptags} keyword directly when setting
5066 @code{org-tag-alist}:
5067
5068 @lisp
5069 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
5070 ("@@read" . nil)
5071 (:grouptags . nil)
5072 ("@@read_book" . nil)
5073 ("@@read_ebook" . nil)
5074 (:endgroup . nil)))
5075 @end lisp
5076
5077 You cannot nest group tags or use a group tag as a tag in another group.
5078
5079 @kindex C-c C-x q
5080 @vindex org-group-tags
5081 If you want to ignore group tags temporarily, toggle group tags support
5082 with @command{org-toggle-tags-groups}, bound to @kbd{C-c C-x q}. If you
5083 want to disable tag groups completely, set @code{org-group-tags} to @code{nil}.
5084
5085 @node Tag searches, , Tag groups, Tags
5086 @section Tag searches
5087 @cindex tag searches
5088 @cindex searching for tags
5089
5090 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
5091 information into special lists.
5092
5093 @table @kbd
5094 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5095 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags/property/TODO search.
5096 With a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5097 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5098 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5099 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. @xref{Matching
5100 tags and properties}.
5101 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5102 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5103 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5104 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see the option
5105 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5106 @end table
5107
5108 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
5109 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
5110 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
5111 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
5112 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
5113 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
5114 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
5115
5116
5117 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
5118 @chapter Properties and columns
5119 @cindex properties
5120
5121 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
5122 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
5123 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
5124
5125 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
5126 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
5127 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
5128 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
5129 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
5130 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
5131 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
5132 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
5133 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
5134
5135 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
5136 (@pxref{Column view}).
5137
5138 @menu
5139 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
5140 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
5141 * Property searches:: Matching property values
5142 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
5143 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
5144 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
5145 @end menu
5146
5147 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
5148 @section Property syntax
5149 @cindex property syntax
5150 @cindex drawer, for properties
5151
5152 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
5153 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
5154 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
5155 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
5156 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
5157
5158 @example
5159 * CD collection
5160 ** Classic
5161 *** Goldberg Variations
5162 :PROPERTIES:
5163 :Title: Goldberg Variations
5164 :Composer: J.S. Bach
5165 :Artist: Glen Gould
5166 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
5167 :NDisks: 1
5168 :END:
5169 @end example
5170
5171 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
5172 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
5173 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
5174
5175 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
5176 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
5177 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
5178 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
5179 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
5180 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
5181 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
5182
5183 @example
5184 * CD collection
5185 :PROPERTIES:
5186 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
5187 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
5188 :END:
5189 @end example
5190
5191 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
5192 file, use a line like
5193 @cindex property, _ALL
5194 @cindex #+PROPERTY
5195 @example
5196 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
5197 @end example
5198
5199 Contrary to properties set from a special drawer, you have to refresh the
5200 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-c} to activate this changes.
5201
5202 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
5203 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
5204 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
5205 @cindex property, +
5206 @example
5207 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
5208 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
5209 @end example
5210
5211 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
5212 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
5213 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
5214 @cindex property, +
5215 @example
5216 * CD collection
5217 ** Classic
5218 :PROPERTIES:
5219 :GENRES: Classic
5220 :END:
5221 *** Goldberg Variations
5222 :PROPERTIES:
5223 :Title: Goldberg Variations
5224 :Composer: J.S. Bach
5225 :Artist: Glen Gould
5226 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
5227 :NDisks: 1
5228 :GENRES+: Baroque
5229 :END:
5230 @end example
5231 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
5232
5233 @vindex org-global-properties
5234 Property values set with the global variable
5235 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
5236 Org files.
5237
5238 @noindent
5239 The following commands help to work with properties:
5240
5241 @table @kbd
5242 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
5243 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
5244 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
5245 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
5246 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
5247 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
5248 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer RET
5249 @cindex org-insert-drawer
5250 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
5251 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
5252 information like deadlines.
5253 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
5254 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
5255 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
5256 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
5257 can be inserted using completion.
5258 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
5259 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
5260 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
5261 Remove a property from the current entry.
5262 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
5263 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
5264 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
5265 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
5266 nearest column format definition.
5267 @end table
5268
5269 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
5270 @section Special properties
5271 @cindex properties, special
5272
5273 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5274 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5275 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5276 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5277 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5278 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5279
5280 @cindex property, special, ID
5281 @cindex property, special, TODO
5282 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5283 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5284 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5285 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5286 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5287 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5288 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5289 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5290 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5291 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5292 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5293 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5294 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5295 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5296 @cindex property, special, FILE
5297 @example
5298 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5299 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5300 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5301 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5302 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5303 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5304 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5305 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5306 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5307 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5308 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5309 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5310 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5311 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5312 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5313 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5314 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5315 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5316 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5317 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5318 @end example
5319
5320 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5321 @section Property searches
5322 @cindex properties, searching
5323 @cindex searching, of properties
5324
5325 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5326 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5327
5328 @table @kbd
5329 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5330 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5331 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5332 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5333 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5334 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5335 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5336 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5337 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5338 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see the option
5339 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5340 @end table
5341
5342 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5343 properties}.
5344
5345 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5346 single property:
5347
5348 @table @kbd
5349 @orgkey{C-c / p}
5350 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5351 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5352 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5353 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5354 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5355 @end table
5356
5357 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5358 @section Property Inheritance
5359 @cindex properties, inheritance
5360 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5361
5362 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5363 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5364 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5365 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5366 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5367 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5368 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5369 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5370 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5371 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5372 inherited properties. If a property has the value @code{nil}, this is
5373 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5374 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5375
5376 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5377 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5378
5379 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5380 @table @code
5381 @item COLUMNS
5382 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5383 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5384 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5385 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5386 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5387 @item CATEGORY
5388 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5389 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5390 applies to the entire subtree.
5391 @item ARCHIVE
5392 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5393 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5394 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5395 @item LOGGING
5396 @cindex property, LOGGING
5397 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5398 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5399 @end table
5400
5401 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5402 @section Column view
5403
5404 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5405 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5406 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5407 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5408 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5409 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5410 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5411 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5412 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5413 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5414 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5415 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5416 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5417
5418 @menu
5419 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5420 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5421 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5422 @end menu
5423
5424 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5425 @subsection Defining columns
5426 @cindex column view, for properties
5427 @cindex properties, column view
5428
5429 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5430 done by defining a column format line.
5431
5432 @menu
5433 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5434 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5435 @end menu
5436
5437 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5438 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5439
5440 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5441
5442 @cindex #+COLUMNS
5443 @example
5444 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5445 @end example
5446
5447 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5448 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5449
5450 @example
5451 ** Top node for columns view
5452 :PROPERTIES:
5453 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5454 :END:
5455 @end example
5456
5457 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5458 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5459 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5460 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5461 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5462 deeper part of the tree.
5463
5464 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5465 @subsubsection Column attributes
5466 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5467 definition looks like this:
5468
5469 @example
5470 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5471 @end example
5472
5473 @noindent
5474 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5475 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5476
5477 @example
5478 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5479 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5480 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5481 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5482 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5483 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5484 @r{name is used.}
5485 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5486 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5487 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5488 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5489 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5490 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5491 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5492 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5493 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5494 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5495 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5496 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5497 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5498 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5499 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5500 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5501 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5502 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5503 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5504 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5505 @end example
5506
5507 @noindent
5508 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5509 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5510 same summary information.
5511
5512 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5513 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5514 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5515 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5516 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5517 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5518
5519 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5520 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5521 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5522 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5523 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5524 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5525 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5526 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5527
5528 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5529 values.
5530
5531 @example
5532 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5533 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5534 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5535 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5536 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5537 @end example
5538
5539 @noindent
5540 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5541 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5542 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5543 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5544 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5545 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5546 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5547 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5548 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5549 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5550 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5551 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5552 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5553 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5554 today.
5555
5556 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5557 @subsection Using column view
5558
5559 @table @kbd
5560 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5561 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5562 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5563 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5564 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5565 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5566 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5567 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5568 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5569 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5570 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5571 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5572 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5573 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5574 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5575 Same as @kbd{r}.
5576 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5577 Exit column view.
5578 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5579 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5580 Move through the column view from field to field.
5581 @kindex S-@key{left}
5582 @kindex S-@key{right}
5583 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5584 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5585 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5586 @item 1..9,0
5587 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5588 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5589 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5590 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5591 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5592 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5593 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5594 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5595 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5596 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5597 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5598 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5599 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5600 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5601 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5602 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5603 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5604 current column view.
5605 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5606 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5607 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5608 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5609 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5610 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5611 Delete the current column.
5612 @end table
5613
5614 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5615 @subsection Capturing column view
5616
5617 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5618 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5619 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5620 of this block looks like this:
5621
5622 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5623 @example
5624 * The column view
5625 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5626
5627 #+END:
5628 @end example
5629
5630 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5631
5632 @table @code
5633 @item :id
5634 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5635 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5636 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5637 capture, you can use 4 values:
5638 @cindex property, ID
5639 @example
5640 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5641 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5642 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5643 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5644 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5645 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5646 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy RET} to create a globally unique ID for}
5647 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5648 @end example
5649 @item :hlines
5650 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5651 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5652 @item :vlines
5653 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5654 @item :maxlevel
5655 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5656 @item :skip-empty-rows
5657 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5658 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5659
5660 @end table
5661
5662 @noindent
5663 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5664
5665 @table @kbd
5666 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5667 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5668 for the scope or ID of the view.
5669 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5670 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5671 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5672 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5673 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5674 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5675 blocks in a buffer.
5676 @end table
5677
5678 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5679 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5680 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5681 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5682
5683 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5684 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5685 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5686 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5687 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5688 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5689 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5690
5691 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5692 @section The Property API
5693 @cindex properties, API
5694 @cindex API, for properties
5695
5696 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5697 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5698 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5699 property API}.
5700
5701 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5702 @chapter Dates and times
5703 @cindex dates
5704 @cindex times
5705 @cindex timestamp
5706 @cindex date stamp
5707
5708 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5709 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5710 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5711 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5712 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5713 is used in a much wider sense.
5714
5715 @menu
5716 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5717 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5718 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5719 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5720 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5721 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5722 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5723 @end menu
5724
5725
5726 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5727 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5728 @cindex timestamps
5729 @cindex ranges, time
5730 @cindex date stamps
5731 @cindex deadlines
5732 @cindex scheduling
5733
5734 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5735 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5736 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5737 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5738 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5739 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5740 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5741 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5742 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5743 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5744
5745 @table @var
5746 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5747 @cindex timestamp
5748 @cindex appointment
5749 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5750 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5751 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5752 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5753
5754 @example
5755 * Meet Peter at the movies
5756 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5757 * Discussion on climate change
5758 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5759 @end example
5760
5761 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5762 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5763 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5764 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5765 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5766 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5767
5768 @example
5769 * Pick up Sam at school
5770 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5771 @end example
5772
5773 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5774 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5775 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5776 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5777 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5778 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5779 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5780 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5781 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5782 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5783 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5784 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5785 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5786 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5787 example with optional time
5788
5789 @example
5790 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5791 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5792 @end example
5793
5794 @item Time/Date range
5795 @cindex timerange
5796 @cindex date range
5797 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5798 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5799 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5800
5801 @example
5802 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5803 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5804 @end example
5805
5806 @item Inactive timestamp
5807 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5808 @cindex inactive timestamp
5809 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5810 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5811 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5812
5813 @example
5814 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5815 [2006-11-01 Wed]
5816 @end example
5817
5818 @end table
5819
5820 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5821 @section Creating timestamps
5822 @cindex creating timestamps
5823 @cindex timestamps, creating
5824
5825 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5826 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5827 format.
5828
5829 @table @kbd
5830 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5831 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5832 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5833 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5834 succession, a time range is inserted.
5835 @c
5836 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5837 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5838 an agenda entry.
5839 @c
5840 @kindex C-u C-c .
5841 @kindex C-u C-c !
5842 @item C-u C-c .
5843 @itemx C-u C-c !
5844 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5845 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5846 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5847 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5848 @c
5849 @orgkey{C-c C-c}
5850 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5851 @c
5852 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5853 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5854 @c
5855 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5856 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5857 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5858 instead.
5859 @c
5860 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5861 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5862 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5863 @c
5864 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5865 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5866 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5867 @c
5868 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5869 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5870 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5871 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5872 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5873 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5874 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5875 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5876 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5877 @c
5878 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5879 @cindex evaluate time range
5880 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5881 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5882 the following column).
5883 @end table
5884
5885
5886 @menu
5887 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5888 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5889 @end menu
5890
5891 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5892 @subsection The date/time prompt
5893 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5894 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5895
5896 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5897 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5898 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5899 format. But it will in fact accept date/time information in a variety of
5900 formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning of the
5901 string. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5902 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5903 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5904 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5905 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5906 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5907 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5908 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5909 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5910 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5911 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5912 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5913
5914 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5915 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5916 in @b{bold}.
5917
5918 @example
5919 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5920 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5921 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5922 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5923 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5924 Fri @result{} nearest Friday after the default date
5925 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5926 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5927 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5928 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5929 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5930 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5931 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5932 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5933 @end example
5934
5935 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the @emph{first}
5936 thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter ([hdwmy]) to
5937 indicate change in hours, days, weeks, months, or years. With a single plus
5938 or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a double plus or minus,
5939 it is relative to the default date. If instead of a single letter, you use
5940 the abbreviation of day name, the date will be the Nth such day, e.g.:
5941
5942 @example
5943 +0 @result{} today
5944 . @result{} today
5945 +4d @result{} four days from today
5946 +4 @result{} same as above
5947 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5948 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5949 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now
5950 -wed @result{} last Wednesday
5951 @end example
5952
5953 @vindex parse-time-months
5954 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5955 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5956 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5957 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5958
5959 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5960 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5961 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5962 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5963 read the docstring of the variable
5964 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5965
5966 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5967 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5968 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5969 case, e.g.:
5970
5971 @example
5972 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5973 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5974 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5975 @end example
5976
5977 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5978 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5979 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5980 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5981 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5982 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5983 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5984 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5985 from the minibuffer:
5986
5987 @kindex <
5988 @kindex >
5989 @kindex M-v
5990 @kindex C-v
5991 @kindex mouse-1
5992 @kindex S-@key{right}
5993 @kindex S-@key{left}
5994 @kindex S-@key{down}
5995 @kindex S-@key{up}
5996 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5997 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5998 @kindex @key{RET}
5999 @example
6000 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
6001 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
6002 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
6003 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
6004 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
6005 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
6006 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
6007 @end example
6008
6009 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
6010 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
6011 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
6012 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
6013 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
6014 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display off with
6015 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
6016
6017 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
6018 @subsection Custom time format
6019 @cindex custom date/time format
6020 @cindex time format, custom
6021 @cindex date format, custom
6022
6023 @vindex org-display-custom-times
6024 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
6025 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
6026 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
6027 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
6028 customizing the options @code{org-display-custom-times} and
6029 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
6030
6031 @table @kbd
6032 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
6033 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
6034 @end table
6035
6036 @noindent
6037 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
6038 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
6039 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
6040 following consequences:
6041 @itemize @bullet
6042 @item
6043 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
6044 after.
6045 @item
6046 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
6047 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
6048 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
6049 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
6050 time will be changed by one minute.
6051 @item
6052 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
6053 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
6054 @item
6055 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
6056 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
6057 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
6058 @item
6059 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
6060 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
6061 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
6062 @end itemize
6063
6064
6065 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
6066 @section Deadlines and scheduling
6067
6068 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
6069
6070 @table @var
6071 @item DEADLINE
6072 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
6073
6074 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
6075 to be finished on that date.
6076
6077 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
6078 @vindex org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled
6079 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
6080 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
6081 approaching or missed deadline, starting
6082 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
6083 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
6084
6085 @example
6086 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
6087 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
6088 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
6089 @end example
6090
6091 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
6092 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
6093 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}. This warning is
6094 deactivated if the task get scheduled and you set
6095 @code{org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled} to @code{t}.
6096
6097 @item SCHEDULED
6098 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
6099
6100 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
6101 date.
6102
6103 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
6104 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
6105 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
6106 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
6107 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
6108 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
6109 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
6110
6111 @example
6112 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
6113 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
6114 @end example
6115
6116 @vindex org-scheduled-delay-days
6117 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline
6118 If you want to @emph{delay} the display of this task in the agenda, use
6119 @code{SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>}: the task is still scheduled on the
6120 25th but will appear two days later. In case the task contains a repeater,
6121 the delay is considered to affect all occurrences; if you want the delay to
6122 only affect the first scheduled occurrence of the task, use @code{--2d}
6123 instead. See @code{org-scheduled-delay-days} and
6124 @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline} for details on how to
6125 control this globally or per agenda.
6126
6127 @noindent
6128 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
6129 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
6130 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
6131 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
6132 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
6133 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
6134 want to start working on an action item.
6135 @end table
6136
6137 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
6138 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
6139 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
6140 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
6141 @c
6142 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
6143 @c
6144 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
6145 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
6146 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
6147 sexp entry matches.
6148
6149 @menu
6150 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
6151 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
6152 @end menu
6153
6154 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
6155 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
6156
6157 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
6158 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
6159 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
6160 an item:
6161
6162 @table @kbd
6163 @c
6164 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
6165 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
6166 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
6167 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
6168 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
6169 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
6170 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
6171 deadline.
6172
6173 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
6174 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
6175 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
6176 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
6177 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
6178 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
6179 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
6180 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
6181 scheduling time.
6182 @c
6183 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
6184 @kindex k a
6185 @kindex k s
6186 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
6187 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
6188 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
6189 schedule the marked item.
6190 @c
6191 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
6192 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
6193 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
6194 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
6195 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
6196 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
6197 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
6198 all deadlines due tomorrow.
6199 @c
6200 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
6201 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
6202 @c
6203 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
6204 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
6205 @end table
6206
6207 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
6208 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
6209 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
6210 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
6211
6212 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
6213 @subsection Repeated tasks
6214 @cindex tasks, repeated
6215 @cindex repeated tasks
6216
6217 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
6218 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
6219 or plain timestamp. In the following example
6220 @example
6221 ** TODO Pay the rent
6222 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
6223 @end example
6224 @noindent
6225 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
6226 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
6227 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
6228 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
6229 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
6230 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
6231
6232 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
6233 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
6234 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
6235 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
6236 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
6237 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
6238 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
6239 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
6240 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
6241 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
6242 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
6243 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
6244 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
6245 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
6246 switch the date like this:
6247
6248 @example
6249 ** TODO Pay the rent
6250 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
6251 @end example
6252
6253 @vindex org-log-repeat
6254 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
6255 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
6256 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
6257 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
6258 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
6259
6260 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
6261 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
6262 will be visible.
6263
6264 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
6265 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
6266 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
6267 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
6268 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
6269 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
6270 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
6271 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
6272 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
6273
6274 @example
6275 ** TODO Call Father
6276 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
6277 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
6278 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
6279 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
6280 and marked it done on Saturday.
6281 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
6282 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
6283 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
6284 today.
6285 @end example
6286
6287 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown
6288 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific task.
6289 If the repeater is set for the scheduling information only, you probably want
6290 the repeater to be ignored after the deadline. If so, set the variable
6291 @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown} to
6292 @code{repeated-after-deadline}. If you want both scheduling and deadline
6293 information to repeat after the same interval, set the same repeater for both
6294 timestamps.
6295
6296 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6297 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6298 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6299
6300
6301 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6302 @section Clocking work time
6303 @cindex clocking time
6304 @cindex time clocking
6305
6306 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6307 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6308 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6309 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6310 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6311 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6312 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6313 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6314 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6315
6316 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6317 @lisp
6318 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6319 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6320 @end lisp
6321 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6322 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6323 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6324 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6325 what to do with it.
6326
6327 @menu
6328 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6329 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6330 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6331 @end menu
6332
6333 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6334 @subsection Clocking commands
6335
6336 @table @kbd
6337 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6338 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6339 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6340 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6341 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6342 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6343 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6344 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6345 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6346 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6347 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6348 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6349 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6350 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6351 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6352 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6353 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6354 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6355 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6356 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6357 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6358 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6359 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6360 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6361 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6362 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6363 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6364 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6365 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6366 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6367 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6368 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6369 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6370 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6371 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6372 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6373 @c
6374 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6375 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6376 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6377 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6378 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6379 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6380 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6381 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6382 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6383 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6384 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6385 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6386 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6387 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6388 stopped.
6389 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6390 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6391 @kindex C-c C-y
6392 @kindex C-c C-c
6393 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6394 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6395 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6396 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6397 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6398 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6399 clock duration keeps the same.
6400 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6401 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6402 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6403 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6404 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6405 increased by five minutes.
6406 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6407 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6408 if it is running in this same item.
6409 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6410 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6411 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6412 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6413 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6414 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6415 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6416 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6417 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6418 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6419 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6420 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6421 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6422 @kbd{C-c C-c}.
6423 @end table
6424
6425 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6426 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6427 worked on or closed during a day.
6428
6429 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6430 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6431 modify the window disposition.
6432
6433 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6434 @subsection The clock table
6435 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6436 @cindex report, of clocked time
6437
6438 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6439 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6440 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6441
6442 @table @kbd
6443 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6444 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6445 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6446 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6447 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6448 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6449 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6450 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6451 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6452 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6453 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6454 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6455 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6456 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6457 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6458 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6459 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6460 @end table
6461
6462
6463 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6464 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6465
6466 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6467 @example
6468 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6469 #+END: clocktable
6470 @end example
6471 @noindent
6472 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6473 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6474 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6475 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6476
6477 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6478 be selected:
6479 @example
6480 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6481 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6482 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6483 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6484 file @r{the full current buffer}
6485 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6486 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6487 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6488 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6489 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6490 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6491 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6492 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6493 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6494 @r{these formats:}
6495 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6496 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6497 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6498 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6499 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6500 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6501 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6502 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6503 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6504 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6505 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6506 @r{Relative times like @code{"<-2w>"} can also be used. See}
6507 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax.}
6508 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6509 @r{Relative times like @code{"<now>"} can also be used. See}
6510 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax.}
6511 :wstart @r{The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for monday.}
6512 :mstart @r{The starting day of the month. The default 1 is for the first}
6513 @r{day of the month.}
6514 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6515 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6516 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6517 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6518 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6519 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6520 @end example
6521
6522 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6523 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6524 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6525 @example
6526 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6527 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6528 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6529 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6530 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6531 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6532 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6533 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6534 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6535 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6536 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6537 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6538 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6539 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6540 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6541 @r{property will get its own column.}
6542 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6543 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6544 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6545 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6546 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6547 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6548 @end example
6549 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6550 day, you could write
6551 @example
6552 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6553 #+END: clocktable
6554 @end example
6555 @noindent
6556 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6557 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6558 only to fit it into the manual.}
6559 @example
6560 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6561 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6562 #+END: clocktable
6563 @end example
6564 A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as
6565 @example
6566 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "<now>"
6567 #+END: clocktable
6568 @end example
6569 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6570 @example
6571 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6572 #+END: clocktable
6573 @end example
6574 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6575 would be
6576 @example
6577 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6578 #+END: clocktable
6579 @end example
6580
6581 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6582 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6583
6584 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6585 @cindex resolve idle time
6586 @vindex org-clock-x11idle-program-name
6587
6588 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6589 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6590 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6591 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6592 applying it to another one.
6593
6594 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6595 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6596 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6597 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6598 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6599 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6600 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, or install the
6601 @file{xprintidle} package and set it to the variable
6602 @code{org-clock-x11idle-program-name} if you are running Debian, to get the
6603 same general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to
6604 Emacs idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time.
6605 There will be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how
6606 much idle time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as
6607 well as a set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6608
6609 @table @kbd
6610 @item k
6611 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6612 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6613 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6614 @item K
6615 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6616 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6617 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6618 @item s
6619 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6620 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6621 @item S
6622 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6623 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6624 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6625 @item C
6626 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6627 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6628 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6629 log with an empty entry.
6630 @end table
6631
6632 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6633 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6634 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6635 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6636 the next task you clock in on.
6637
6638 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6639 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6640 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6641 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6642 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6643
6644 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6645 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6646 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6647 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6648 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6649 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6650
6651 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6652 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6653
6654 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6655 @cindex continuous clocking
6656 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6657
6658 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6659 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6660 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6661 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6662
6663 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6664 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6665
6666 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6667 @section Effort estimates
6668 @cindex effort estimates
6669
6670 @cindex property, Effort
6671 @vindex org-effort-property
6672 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6673 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6674 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6675 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6676 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6677 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6678 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6679 for an entry with the following commands:
6680
6681 @table @kbd
6682 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6683 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6684 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6685 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6686 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6687 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6688 @end table
6689
6690 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6691 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6692 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6693 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6694 buffer you can use
6695
6696 @example
6697 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6698 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6699 @end example
6700
6701 @noindent
6702 @vindex org-global-properties
6703 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6704 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6705 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6706 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6707 setup may be advised.
6708
6709 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6710 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6711 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6712 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6713
6714 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6715 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6716 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6717 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6718 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6719 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6720 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6721 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6722 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6723
6724 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6725 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6726 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6727 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6728
6729 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6730 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6731 @cindex relative timer
6732
6733 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6734 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6735 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6736
6737 @table @kbd
6738 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6739 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6740 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6741 restarted.
6742 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6743 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6744 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6745 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6746 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6747 new timer items.
6748 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6749 @kindex C-c C-x ,
6750 @item C-c C-x ,
6751 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6752 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6753 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6754 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6755 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
6756 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6757 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6758 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6759 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6760 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6761 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6762 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6763 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6764 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6765 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6766 not started at exactly the right moment.
6767 @end table
6768
6769 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6770 @section Countdown timer
6771 @cindex Countdown timer
6772 @kindex C-c C-x ;
6773 @kindex ;
6774
6775 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6776 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6777
6778 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6779 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6780 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6781 default value.
6782
6783 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6784 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6785 @cindex capture
6786
6787 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6788 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6789 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6790 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6791 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6792 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6793
6794 @menu
6795 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6796 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6797 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6798 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6799 * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another
6800 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6801 @end menu
6802
6803 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6804 @section Capture
6805 @cindex capture
6806
6807 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6808 flow. Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John
6809 Wiegley excellent @file{remember.el} package. Up to version 6.36, Org
6810 used a special setup for @file{remember.el}, then replaced it with
6811 @file{org-remember.el}. As of version 8.0, @file{org-remember.el} has
6812 been completely replaced by @file{org-capture.el}.
6813
6814 If your configuration depends on @file{org-remember.el}, you need to update
6815 it and use the setup described below. To convert your
6816 @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6817 @example
6818 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates RET}
6819 @end example
6820 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6821 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6822 customization.
6823
6824 @menu
6825 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6826 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6827 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6828 @end menu
6829
6830 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6831 @subsection Setting up capture
6832
6833 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6834 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6835 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6836
6837 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6838 @smalllisp
6839 @group
6840 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6841 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6842 @end group
6843 @end smalllisp
6844
6845 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6846 @subsection Using capture
6847
6848 @table @kbd
6849 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6850 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6851 not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates
6852 @cindex date tree
6853 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6854 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6855 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6856 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6857
6858 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6859 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6860 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6861 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6862 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6863
6864 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6865 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refile and copy}) the note to
6866 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6867 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6868 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6869 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6870 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6871
6872 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6873 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6874
6875 @end table
6876
6877 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6878 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6879 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6880 rather than to the current date.
6881
6882 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6883 prefix commands:
6884
6885 @table @kbd
6886 @orgkey{C-u C-c c}
6887 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6888 template in the usual way.
6889 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6890 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6891 @end table
6892
6893 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6894 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6895 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6896 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6897 @code{nil}.
6898
6899 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6900 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6901
6902 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6903 @subsection Capture templates
6904 @cindex templates, for Capture
6905
6906 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6907 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6908 through the customize interface.
6909
6910 @table @kbd
6911 @orgkey{C-c c C}
6912 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6913 @end table
6914
6915 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6916 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6917 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6918 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6919 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6920 would look like:
6921
6922 @smalllisp
6923 @group
6924 (setq org-capture-templates
6925 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6926 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6927 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6928 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6929 @end group
6930 @end smalllisp
6931
6932 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6933 for you like this:
6934 @example
6935 * TODO
6936 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6937 @end example
6938
6939 @noindent
6940 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6941 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6942 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6943 the task definition, press @kbd{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6944 place where you started the capture process.
6945
6946 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6947 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6948 like this:
6949
6950 @lisp
6951 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6952 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6953 @end lisp
6954
6955 @menu
6956 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6957 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6958 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6959 @end menu
6960
6961 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6962 @subsubsection Template elements
6963
6964 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6965 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6966
6967 @table @var
6968 @item keys
6969 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6970 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6971 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6972 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6973 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6974 prefix key, for example
6975 @smalllisp
6976 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6977 @end smalllisp
6978 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6979 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6980
6981 @item description
6982 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6983 selection.
6984
6985 @item type
6986 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6987
6988 @table @code
6989 @item entry
6990 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6991 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6992 @item item
6993 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6994 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6995 @item checkitem
6996 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6997 default template.
6998 @item table-line
6999 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
7000 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
7001 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
7002 @item plain
7003 Text to be inserted as it is.
7004 @end table
7005
7006 @item target
7007 @vindex org-default-notes-file
7008 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
7009 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
7010 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
7011 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
7012 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
7013 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
7014
7015 Valid values are:
7016
7017 @table @code
7018 @item (file "path/to/file")
7019 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
7020
7021 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
7022 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
7023
7024 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
7025 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
7026
7027 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
7028 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
7029
7030 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
7031 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
7032
7033 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
7034 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date@footnote{Datetree
7035 headlines for years accept tags, so if you use both @code{* 2013 :noexport:}
7036 and @code{* 2013} in your file, the capture will refile the note to the first
7037 one matched.}.
7038
7039 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
7040 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
7041
7042 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
7043 A function to find the right location in the file.
7044
7045 @item (clock)
7046 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
7047
7048 @item (function function-finding-location)
7049 Most general way, write your own function to find both
7050 file and location.
7051 @end table
7052
7053 @item template
7054 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
7055 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
7056 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
7057 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
7058 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
7059 more details.
7060
7061 @item properties
7062 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
7063 Recognized properties are:
7064
7065 @table @code
7066 @item :prepend
7067 Normally new captured information will be appended at
7068 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
7069 Setting this property will change that.
7070
7071 @item :immediate-finish
7072 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
7073 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
7074 information that can be added automatically.
7075
7076 @item :empty-lines
7077 Set this to the number of lines to insert
7078 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
7079
7080 @item :clock-in
7081 Start the clock in this item.
7082
7083 @item :clock-keep
7084 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
7085
7086 @item :clock-resume
7087 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
7088 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
7089 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
7090 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
7091
7092 @item :unnarrowed
7093 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
7094 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
7095
7096 @item :table-line-pos
7097 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
7098 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
7099 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
7100 line.
7101
7102 @item :kill-buffer
7103 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
7104 buffer again after capture is completed.
7105 @end table
7106 @end table
7107
7108 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
7109 @subsubsection Template expansion
7110
7111 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
7112 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
7113 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
7114
7115 @smallexample
7116 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
7117 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
7118 @r{For convenience, %:keyword (see below) placeholders}
7119 @r{within the expression will be expanded prior to this.}
7120 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
7121 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
7122 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
7123 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
7124 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
7125 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
7126 @r{region is active.}
7127 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
7128 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
7129 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
7130 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
7131 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
7132 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
7133 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
7134 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
7135 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
7136 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
7137 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
7138 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
7139 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
7140 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
7141 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
7142 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
7143 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
7144 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
7145 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
7146 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
7147 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
7148 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
7149 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
7150 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
7151 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
7152 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
7153 @end smallexample
7154
7155 @noindent
7156 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
7157 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
7158 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
7159 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
7160 similar way.}:
7161
7162 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
7163 @smallexample
7164 Link type | Available keywords
7165 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
7166 bbdb | %:name %:company
7167 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
7168 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
7169 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
7170 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
7171 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
7172 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
7173 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
7174 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
7175 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
7176 w3, w3m | %:url
7177 info | %:file %:node
7178 calendar | %:date
7179 @end smallexample
7180
7181 @noindent
7182 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
7183
7184 @smallexample
7185 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
7186 @end smallexample
7187
7188 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
7189 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
7190
7191 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
7192 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
7193 context, you can customize @code{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
7194 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
7195 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
7196
7197 @smalllisp
7198 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
7199 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
7200 @end smalllisp
7201
7202 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
7203 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
7204
7205 @smalllisp
7206 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
7207 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
7208 @end smalllisp
7209
7210 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
7211
7212 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
7213 @section Attachments
7214 @cindex attachments
7215
7216 @vindex org-attach-directory
7217 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
7218 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
7219 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
7220 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
7221 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
7222 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
7223 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
7224 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
7225 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
7226 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
7227 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
7228 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
7229 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
7230
7231 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
7232 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
7233 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
7234 directory.
7235
7236 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
7237
7238 @table @kbd
7239 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
7240 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
7241 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
7242 to select a command:
7243
7244 @table @kbd
7245 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
7246 @vindex org-attach-method
7247 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
7248 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
7249 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
7250
7251 @kindex C-c C-a c
7252 @kindex C-c C-a m
7253 @kindex C-c C-a l
7254 @item c/m/l
7255 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
7256 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
7257
7258 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
7259 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
7260
7261 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
7262 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
7263 attachments yourself.
7264
7265 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
7266 @vindex org-file-apps
7267 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
7268 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
7269 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
7270 (@pxref{Handling links}).
7271
7272 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
7273 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
7274
7275 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
7276 Open the current task's attachment directory.
7277
7278 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
7279 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
7280
7281 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
7282 Select and delete a single attachment.
7283
7284 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
7285 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
7286 @command{dired} and delete from there.
7287
7288 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
7289 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
7290 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
7291 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
7292
7293 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
7294 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
7295 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
7296 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
7297 @end table
7298 @end table
7299
7300 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
7301 @section RSS feeds
7302 @cindex RSS feeds
7303 @cindex Atom feeds
7304
7305 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
7306 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
7307 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
7308 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
7309 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
7310 information. Here is just an example:
7311
7312 @smalllisp
7313 @group
7314 (setq org-feed-alist
7315 '(("Slashdot"
7316 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7317 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7318 @end group
7319 @end smalllisp
7320
7321 @noindent
7322 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7323 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7324 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7325 the following command is used:
7326
7327 @table @kbd
7328 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7329 @item C-c C-x g
7330 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7331 them.
7332 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7333 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7334 @end table
7335
7336 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7337 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7338 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7339 list of drawers in that file:
7340
7341 @example
7342 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7343 @end example
7344
7345 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7346 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7347
7348 @node Protocols, Refile and copy, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7349 @section Protocols for external access
7350 @cindex protocols, for external access
7351 @cindex emacsserver
7352
7353 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7354 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7355 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7356 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7357 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7358 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7359 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7360 documentation and setup instructions.
7361
7362 @node Refile and copy, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7363 @section Refile and copy
7364 @cindex refiling notes
7365 @cindex copying notes
7366
7367 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy some of
7368 the entries into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting,
7369 finding the right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To
7370 simplify this process, you can use the following special command:
7371
7372 @table @kbd
7373 @orgcmd{C-c M-w,org-copy}
7374 @findex org-copy
7375 Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not deleted.
7376 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7377 @findex org-refile
7378 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7379 @vindex org-refile-targets
7380 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7381 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7382 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7383 @vindex org-log-refile
7384 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7385 @vindex org-refile-keep
7386 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7387 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7388 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7389 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7390 last subitem.@*
7391 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7392 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7393 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7394 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7395 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7396 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7397 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7398 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7399 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7400 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7401 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7402 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7403 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7404 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7405 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7406 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7407 @item C-2 C-c C-w
7408 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7409 @item C-3 C-c C-w
7410 Refile and keep the entry in place. Also see @code{org-refile-keep} to make
7411 this the default behavior, and beware that this may result in duplicated
7412 @code{ID} properties.
7413 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7414 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7415 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7416 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7417 @end table
7418
7419 @node Archiving, , Refile and copy, Capture - Refile - Archive
7420 @section Archiving
7421 @cindex archiving
7422
7423 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7424 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7425 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7426 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7427
7428 @table @kbd
7429 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7430 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7431 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7432 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7433 @end table
7434
7435 @menu
7436 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7437 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7438 @end menu
7439
7440 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7441 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7442 @cindex external archiving
7443
7444 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7445 the archive file.
7446
7447 @table @kbd
7448 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7449 @vindex org-archive-location
7450 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7451 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7452 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7453 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7454 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7455 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7456 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7457 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7458 @end table
7459
7460 @cindex archive locations
7461 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7462 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7463 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7464 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7465 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7466 see the documentation string of the variable
7467 @code{org-archive-location}.
7468
7469 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7470 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7471 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7472 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7473 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7474 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7475 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7476 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7477
7478 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
7479 @example
7480 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7481 @end example
7482
7483 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7484 @noindent
7485 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7486 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7487 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7488
7489 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7490 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7491 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7492 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7493 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7494 added.
7495
7496
7497 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7498 @subsection Internal archiving
7499
7500 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7501 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7502
7503 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7504 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7505 @itemize @minus
7506 @item
7507 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7508 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7509 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7510 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7511 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7512 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7513 @item
7514 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7515 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7516 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7517 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7518 @item
7519 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7520 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7521 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7522 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7523 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7524 temporarily included.
7525 @item
7526 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7527 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7528 is. Configure the details using the variable
7529 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7530 @item
7531 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7532 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7533 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7534 @end itemize
7535
7536 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7537
7538 @table @kbd
7539 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7540 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7541 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7542 hidden.
7543 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7544 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7545 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7546 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7547 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7548 level 1 trees will be checked.
7549 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7550 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7551 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7552 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7553 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7554 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7555 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7556 outline.
7557 @end table
7558
7559
7560 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7561 @chapter Agenda views
7562 @cindex agenda views
7563
7564 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7565 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7566 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7567 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7568 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7569
7570 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7571 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7572
7573 @itemize @bullet
7574 @item
7575 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7576 for specific dates,
7577 @item
7578 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7579 action items,
7580 @item
7581 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7582 TODO state associated with them,
7583 @item
7584 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7585 in time-sorted view,
7586 @item
7587 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7588 that contain specified keywords,
7589 @item
7590 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7591 along, and
7592 @item
7593 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7594 views.
7595 @end itemize
7596
7597 @noindent
7598 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7599 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7600 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7601 edit these files remotely.
7602
7603 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7604 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7605 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7606 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7607 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7608 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7609
7610 @menu
7611 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7612 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7613 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7614 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7615 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7616 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7617 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7618 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7619 @end menu
7620
7621 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7622 @section Agenda files
7623 @cindex agenda files
7624 @cindex files for agenda
7625
7626 @vindex org-agenda-files
7627 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7628 files}, the files listed in the variable
7629 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7630 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7631 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7632 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7633 of the list.
7634
7635 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7636 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7637 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7638 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7639 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7640 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7641
7642 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7643 @table @kbd
7644 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7645 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7646 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7647 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7648 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7649 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7650 @kindex C-,
7651 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7652 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7653 @itemx C-,
7654 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7655 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7656 @item M-x org-iswitchb RET
7657 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7658 buffers.
7659 @end table
7660
7661 @noindent
7662 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7663 to visit any of them.
7664
7665 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7666 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7667 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7668 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7669 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7670 extended period, use the following commands:
7671
7672 @table @kbd
7673 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7674 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7675 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7676 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7677 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7678 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7679 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7680 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7681 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7682 @end table
7683
7684 @noindent
7685 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7686 the Speedbar frame:
7687
7688 @table @kbd
7689 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7690 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7691 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7692 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7693 effect immediately.
7694 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7695 Lift the restriction.
7696 @end table
7697
7698 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7699 @section The agenda dispatcher
7700 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7701 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7702 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7703 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7704 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7705 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7706 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7707 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7708
7709 @table @kbd
7710 @item a
7711 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7712 @item t @r{/} T
7713 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7714 @item m @r{/} M
7715 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7716 tags and properties}).
7717 @item L
7718 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7719 @item s
7720 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7721 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7722 @item /
7723 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7724 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7725 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7726 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7727 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7728 1.
7729 @item # @r{/} !
7730 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7731 @item <
7732 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7733 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7734 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7735 selecting the command.
7736 @item < <
7737 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7738 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7739 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7740 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7741 character selecting the command.
7742
7743 @item *
7744 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7745 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7746 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7747 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7748 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7749 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7750 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7751 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7752 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7753 @end table
7754
7755 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7756 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7757 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7758 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7759 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7760
7761 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7762 @section The built-in agenda views
7763
7764 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7765
7766 @menu
7767 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7768 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7769 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7770 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7771 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7772 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7773 @end menu
7774
7775 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7776 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7777 @cindex agenda
7778 @cindex weekly agenda
7779 @cindex daily agenda
7780
7781 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7782 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7783
7784 @table @kbd
7785 @cindex org-agenda, command
7786 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7787 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7788 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7789 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7790 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7791 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7792 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7793 @end table
7794
7795 @vindex org-agenda-span
7796 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7797 @vindex org-agenda-start-day
7798 @vindex org-agenda-start-on-weekday
7799 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7800 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7801 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7802 agenda, or to a span name, such as @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7803 @code{year}. For weekly agendas, the default is to start on the previous
7804 monday (see @code{org-agenda-start-on-weekday}). You can also set the start
7805 date using a date shift: @code{(setq org-agenda-start-day "+10d")} will
7806 start the agenda ten days from today in the future.
7807
7808 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7809 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7810 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7811 commands}.
7812
7813 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7814 @cindex calendar integration
7815 @cindex diary integration
7816
7817 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7818 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7819 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7820 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7821 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7822 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7823 the diary.
7824
7825 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7826 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7827
7828 @lisp
7829 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7830 @end lisp
7831
7832 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7833 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7834 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7835 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7836 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7837 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7838 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7839 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7840 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7841 between calendar and agenda.
7842
7843 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7844 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7845 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7846 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7847 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7848 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7849 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7850 will be made in the agenda:
7851
7852 @example
7853 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7854 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
7855 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7856 #+CATEGORY: Ann
7857 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7858 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7859 @end example
7860
7861 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7862 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7863 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7864
7865 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7866 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7867 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7868 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7869 following to one of your agenda files:
7870
7871 @example
7872 * Anniversaries
7873 :PROPERTIES:
7874 :CATEGORY: Anniv
7875 :END:
7876 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7877 @end example
7878
7879 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7880 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7881 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7882 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7883 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7884 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7885 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7886
7887 @example
7888 1973-06-22
7889 06-22
7890 1955-08-02 wedding
7891 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7892 @end example
7893
7894 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7895 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7896 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7897 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7898 in an Org or Diary file.
7899
7900 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7901 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7902 @cindex appointment reminders
7903 @cindex appointment
7904 @cindex reminders
7905
7906 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7907 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7908 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7909 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7910 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7911 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7912 docstring for details.
7913
7914 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7915 @subsection The global TODO list
7916 @cindex global TODO list
7917 @cindex TODO list, global
7918
7919 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7920 collected into a single place.
7921
7922 @table @kbd
7923 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7924 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7925 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7926 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7927 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7928 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7929 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7930 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7931 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7932 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7933 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7934 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7935 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7936 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7937 @kindex r
7938 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7939 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7940 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7941 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7942 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7943 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7944 @end table
7945
7946 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7947 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7948 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7949
7950 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7951 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7952 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7953 it more compact:
7954 @itemize @minus
7955 @item
7956 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7957 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7958 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7959 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7960 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7961 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7962 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7963 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7964 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7965 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7966 TODO list.
7967 @item
7968 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7969 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7970 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7971 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7972 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7973 @end itemize
7974
7975 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7976 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7977 @cindex matching, of tags
7978 @cindex matching, of properties
7979 @cindex tags view
7980 @cindex match view
7981
7982 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7983 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7984 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7985 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7986 m}.
7987
7988 @table @kbd
7989 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7990 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7991 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7992 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7993 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7994 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7995 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7996 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7997 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7998 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7999 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
8000 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
8001 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
8002 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
8003 @ref{Tag searches}.
8004 @end table
8005
8006 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
8007 commands}.
8008
8009 @subsubheading Match syntax
8010
8011 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
8012 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for @code{AND} and
8013 @samp{|} for @code{OR}@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}.
8014 Parentheses are not implemented. Each element in the search is either a
8015 tag, a regular expression matching tags, or an expression like
8016 @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a
8017 property value. Each element may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select
8018 against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for positive selection. The
8019 @code{AND} operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+} or @samp{-} is
8020 present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
8021
8022 @table @samp
8023 @item work
8024 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}.
8025 @item work&boss
8026 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:} and @samp{:boss:}.
8027 @item +work-boss
8028 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
8029 @samp{:boss:}.
8030 @item work|laptop
8031 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
8032 @item work|laptop+night
8033 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
8034 @samp{:night:}.
8035 @end table
8036
8037 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
8038 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
8039 braces. For example,
8040 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
8041 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
8042
8043 @cindex group tags, as regular expressions
8044 Group tags (@pxref{Tag groups}) are expanded as regular expressions. E.g.,
8045 if @samp{:work:} is a group tag for the group @samp{:work:lab:conf:}, then
8046 searching for @samp{work} will search for @samp{@{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)@}}
8047 and searching for @samp{-work} will search for all headlines but those with
8048 one of the tag in the group (i.e., @samp{-@{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)@}}).
8049
8050 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
8051 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
8052 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
8053 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
8054 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
8055 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
8056 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
8057 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
8058 entry and the ``property'' @code{PRIORITY} represents the PRIORITY keyword of
8059 the entry. The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
8060 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
8061 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
8062
8063 Except the @pxref{Special properties}, one other ``property'' can also be
8064 used. @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry. So a search
8065 @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines that have
8066 the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword DONE@.
8067 In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not count
8068 the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
8069
8070 Here are more examples:
8071
8072 @table @samp
8073 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
8074 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
8075 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
8076 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
8077 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
8078 @end table
8079
8080 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
8081 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
8082
8083 @example
8084 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
8085 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
8086 @end example
8087
8088 @noindent
8089 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
8090 @itemize @minus
8091 @item
8092 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
8093 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
8094 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
8095 @item
8096 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
8097 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
8098 @item
8099 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
8100 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
8101 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
8102 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
8103 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
8104 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
8105 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
8106 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
8107 respectively, can be used.
8108 @item
8109 If the comparison value is enclosed
8110 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
8111 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
8112 match.
8113 @end itemize
8114
8115 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
8116 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
8117 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
8118 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
8119 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
8120 on or after October 11, 2008.
8121
8122 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
8123 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
8124 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
8125 again.
8126
8127 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
8128 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
8129 inheritance}, for details.
8130
8131 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
8132 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
8133 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
8134 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
8135 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
8136 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
8137 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
8138 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
8139 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
8140 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
8141 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
8142 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
8143
8144 @table @samp
8145 @item work/WAITING
8146 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
8147 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
8148 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
8149 nor @samp{NEXT}
8150 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
8151 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
8152 @samp{NEXT}.
8153 @end table
8154
8155 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
8156 @subsection Timeline for a single file
8157 @cindex timeline, single file
8158 @cindex time-sorted view
8159
8160 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
8161 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
8162 to give an overview over events in a project.
8163
8164 @table @kbd
8165 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
8166 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
8167 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
8168 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
8169 @end table
8170
8171 @noindent
8172 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
8173 @ref{Agenda commands}.
8174
8175 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
8176 @subsection Search view
8177 @cindex search view
8178 @cindex text search
8179 @cindex searching, for text
8180
8181 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
8182 It is particularly useful to find notes.
8183
8184 @table @kbd
8185 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
8186 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
8187 or specific words using a boolean logic.
8188 @end table
8189 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
8190 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
8191 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
8192 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
8193 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
8194 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
8195 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
8196 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
8197 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
8198 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
8199 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
8200
8201 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
8202 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
8203 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
8204
8205 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
8206 @subsection Stuck projects
8207 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
8208
8209 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
8210 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
8211 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
8212 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
8213 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
8214 projects and define next actions for them.
8215
8216 @table @kbd
8217 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
8218 List projects that are stuck.
8219 @kindex C-c a !
8220 @item C-c a !
8221 @vindex org-stuck-projects
8222 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
8223 project is and how to find it.
8224 @end table
8225
8226 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
8227 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
8228 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
8229 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
8230
8231 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
8232 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
8233 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
8234 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
8235 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
8236 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
8237 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
8238 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
8239 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
8240 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
8241 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
8242 correct customization for this is
8243
8244 @lisp
8245 (setq org-stuck-projects
8246 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
8247 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
8248 @end lisp
8249
8250 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
8251 will still be searched for stuck projects.
8252
8253 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
8254 @section Presentation and sorting
8255 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
8256
8257 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
8258 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
8259 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
8260 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
8261 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
8262 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
8263 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
8264 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
8265 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
8266 associated with the item.
8267
8268 @menu
8269 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
8270 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
8271 * Sorting agenda items:: The order of things
8272 * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda
8273 @end menu
8274
8275 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
8276 @subsection Categories
8277
8278 @cindex category
8279 @cindex #+CATEGORY
8280 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
8281 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
8282 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
8283 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
8284 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
8285 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
8286 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
8287 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
8288 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
8289 property.}:
8290
8291 @example
8292 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
8293 @end example
8294
8295 @noindent
8296 @cindex property, CATEGORY
8297 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
8298 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
8299 special category you want to apply as the value.
8300
8301 @noindent
8302 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
8303 longer than 10 characters.
8304
8305 @noindent
8306 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
8307 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
8308
8309 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
8310 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
8311 @cindex time-of-day specification
8312
8313 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
8314 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
8315 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
8316 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
8317 @c
8318 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
8319
8320 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
8321 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
8322 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
8323 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
8324
8325 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
8326 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
8327 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
8328
8329 @example
8330 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8331 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8332 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8333 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8334 @end example
8335
8336 @cindex time grid
8337 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
8338 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
8339
8340 @example
8341 8:00...... ------------------
8342 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8343 10:00...... ------------------
8344 12:00...... ------------------
8345 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8346 14:00...... ------------------
8347 16:00...... ------------------
8348 18:00...... ------------------
8349 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8350 20:00...... ------------------
8351 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8352 @end example
8353
8354 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8355 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8356 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8357 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8358 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8359
8360 @node Sorting agenda items, Filtering/limiting agenda items, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8361 @subsection Sorting agenda items
8362 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8363 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8364 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8365 done depends on the type of view.
8366 @itemize @bullet
8367 @item
8368 @vindex org-agenda-files
8369 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8370 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8371 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8372 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8373 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8374 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8375 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8376 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8377 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8378 @item
8379 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8380 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8381 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8382 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8383 or scheduled date.
8384 @item
8385 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8386 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8387 @end itemize
8388
8389 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8390 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8391 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8392 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8393
8394 @node Filtering/limiting agenda items, , Sorting agenda items, Presentation and sorting
8395 @subsection Filtering/limiting agenda items
8396
8397 Agenda built-in or customized commands are statically defined. Agenda
8398 filters and limits provide two ways of dynamically narrowing down the list of
8399 agenda entries: @emph{fitlers} and @emph{limits}. Filters only act on the
8400 display of the items, while limits take effect before the list of agenda
8401 entries is built. Filter are more often used interactively, while limits are
8402 mostly useful when defined as local variables within custom agenda commands.
8403
8404 @subsubheading Filtering in the agenda
8405 @cindex filtering, by tag, category, top headline and effort, in agenda
8406 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8407 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8408 @cindex top headline filtering, in agenda
8409 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8410 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8411
8412 @table @kbd
8413 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8414 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8415 Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates. The
8416 difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is very
8417 fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without having
8418 to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8419 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8420 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8421 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8422 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8423 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8424
8425 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8426 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8427 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8428 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8429 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8430 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8431 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8432 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8433 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8434 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8435
8436 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8437 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8438 efforts globally, for example
8439 @lisp
8440 (setq org-global-properties
8441 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8442 @end lisp
8443 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8444 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8445 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8446 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8447 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0--9 are not used
8448 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8449 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8450 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8451 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8452 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8453
8454 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8455 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8456 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8457 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8458 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8459 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8460 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8461 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8462 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8463
8464 @smalllisp
8465 @group
8466 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8467 (and (cond
8468 ((string= tag "Net")
8469 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8470 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8471 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8472 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8473 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8474 (concat "-" tag)))
8475
8476 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8477 @end group
8478 @end smalllisp
8479
8480 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8481 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8482 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8483 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8484 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8485
8486 @c
8487 @kindex [
8488 @kindex ]
8489 @kindex @{
8490 @kindex @}
8491 @item [ ] @{ @}
8492 @table @i
8493 @item @r{in} search view
8494 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8495 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8496 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8497 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8498 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8499 selected.
8500 @end table
8501
8502 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8503 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8504
8505 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8506 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8507 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8508 (see below.)
8509
8510 @orgcmd{^,org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline}
8511 Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and the parent
8512 headline of the one at point.
8513
8514 @orgcmd{=,org-agenda-filter-by-regexp}
8515 @vindex org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset
8516
8517 Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda entries
8518 matching the regular expression the user entered. When called with a prefix
8519 argument, it will filter @emph{out} entries matching the regexp. With two
8520 universal prefix arguments, it will remove all the regexp filters, which can
8521 be accumulated. You can add a filter preset through the option
8522 @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset} (see below.)
8523
8524 @orgcmd{|,org-agenda-filter-remove-all}
8525 Remove all filters in the current agenda view.
8526 @end table
8527
8528 @subsubheading Setting limits for the agenda
8529 @cindex limits, in agenda
8530 @vindex org-agenda-max-entries
8531 @vindex org-agenda-max-effort
8532 @vindex org-agenda-max-todos
8533 @vindex org-agenda-max-tags
8534
8535 Here is a list of options that you can set, either globally, or locally in
8536 your custom agenda views@pxref{Custom agenda views}.
8537
8538 @table @var
8539 @item org-agenda-max-entries
8540 Limit the number of entries.
8541 @item org-agenda-max-effort
8542 Limit the duration of accumulated efforts (as minutes).
8543 @item org-agenda-max-todos
8544 Limit the number of entries with TODO keywords.
8545 @item org-agenda-max-tags
8546 Limit the number of tagged entries.
8547 @end table
8548
8549 When set to a positive integer, each option will exclude entries from other
8550 categories: for example, @code{(setq org-agenda-max-effort 100)} will limit
8551 the agenda to 100 minutes of effort and exclude any entry that as no effort
8552 property. If you want to include entries with no effort property, use a
8553 negative value for @code{org-agenda-max-effort}.
8554
8555 One useful setup is to use @code{org-agenda-max-entries} locally in a custom
8556 command. For example, this custom command will display the next five entries
8557 with a @code{NEXT} TODO keyword.
8558
8559 @smalllisp
8560 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8561 '(("n" todo "NEXT"
8562 ((org-agenda-max-entries 5)))))
8563 @end smalllisp
8564
8565 Once you mark one of these five entry as @code{DONE}, rebuilding the agenda
8566 will again the next five entries again, including the first entry that was
8567 excluded so far.
8568
8569 You can also dynamically set temporary limits@footnote{Those temporary limits
8570 are lost when rebuilding the agenda.}:
8571
8572 @table @kbd
8573 @orgcmd{~,org-agenda-limit-interactively}
8574 This prompts for the type of limit to apply and its value.
8575 @end table
8576
8577 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8578 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8579 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8580
8581 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8582 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8583 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8584 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8585 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8586 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8587
8588 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8589 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8590
8591 @table @kbd
8592 @tsubheading{Motion}
8593 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8594 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8595 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8596 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8597 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8598 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8599 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8600 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8601 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8602 outline, not only the heading.
8603 @c
8604 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8605 Display original location and recenter that window.
8606 @c
8607 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8608 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8609 @c
8610 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8611 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8612 @c
8613 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8614 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8615 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8616 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8617 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8618 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8619 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8620 @c
8621 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8622 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8623 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8624 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8625 previously used indirect buffer.
8626
8627 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8628 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8629 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8630 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8631
8632 @tsubheading{Change display}
8633 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8634 @kindex A
8635 @item A
8636 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8637 @c
8638 @kindex o
8639 @item o
8640 Delete other windows.
8641 @c
8642 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8643 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8644 @xorgcmd{v t,org-agenda-fortnight-view}
8645 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8646 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8647 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8648 @vindex org-agenda-span
8649 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8650 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8651 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8652 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8653 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8654 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8655 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8656 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8657 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8658 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8659 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8660 @c
8661 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8662 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8663 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8664 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8665 @c
8666 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8667 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8668 @c
8669 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8670 Go to today.
8671 @c
8672 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8673 Prompt for a date and go there.
8674 @c
8675 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8676 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8677 @c
8678 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8679 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8680 @c
8681 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8682 @kindex v L
8683 @vindex org-log-done
8684 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8685 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8686 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8687 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8688 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8689 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8690 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8691 prefix arguments @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8692 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8693 @c
8694 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8695 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8696 agenda and timeline views.
8697 @c
8698 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8699 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8700 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8701 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8702 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8703 press @kbd{v a} again.
8704 @c
8705 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8706 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8707 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8708 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8709 always show a table with the clocked times for the time span and file scope
8710 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8711 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8712 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8713 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8714 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8715 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8716 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8717 @c
8718 @orgkey{v c}
8719 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8720 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8721 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8722 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8723 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8724 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8725 mode.
8726 @c
8727 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8728 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8729 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8730 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8731 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8732 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8733 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8734 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8735 @c
8736 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8737 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8738 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8739 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8740 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8741 @c
8742 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8743 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8744 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8745 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8746 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8747 keyword.
8748 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8749 Same as @kbd{r}.
8750 @c
8751 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8752 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8753 IDs.
8754 @c
8755 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8756 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8757 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8758 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8759 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8760 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8761 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8762 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8763
8764 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8765 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8766 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8767
8768 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8769
8770 For a detailed description of these commands, see @pxref{Filtering/limiting
8771 agenda items}.
8772
8773 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8774 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8775 Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8776
8777 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8778 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition.
8779
8780 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8781 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8782
8783 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8784 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter.
8785
8786 @orgcmd{^,org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline}
8787 Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and the parent
8788 headline of the one at point.
8789
8790 @orgcmd{=,org-agenda-filter-by-regexp}
8791 @vindex org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset
8792
8793 Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda entries
8794 matching the regular expression the user entered. When called with a prefix
8795 argument, it will filter @emph{out} entries matching the regexp. With two
8796 universal prefix arguments, it will remove all the regexp filters, which can
8797 be accumulated. You can add a filter preset through the option
8798 @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset} (see below.)
8799
8800 @orgcmd{|,org-agenda-filter-remove-all}
8801 Remove all filters in the current agenda view.
8802
8803 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8804 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8805
8806 @item 0--9
8807 Digit argument.
8808 @c
8809 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8810 @cindex remote editing, undo
8811 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8812 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8813 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8814 @c
8815 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8816 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8817 original org file.
8818 @c
8819 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8820 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8821 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8822 @c
8823 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8824 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8825 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8826 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8827 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8828 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8829 @c
8830 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8831 Refile the entry at point.
8832 @c
8833 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8834 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8835 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8836 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8837 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8838 @c
8839 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8840 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8841 @c
8842 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8843 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8844 sibling}.
8845 @c
8846 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8847 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8848 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8849 different file.
8850 @c
8851 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8852 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8853 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8854 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8855 tags of a headline occasionally.
8856 @c
8857 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8858 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8859 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8860 @c
8861 @kindex ,
8862 @item ,
8863 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8864 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8865 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8866 @c
8867 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8868 Display weighted priority of current item.
8869 @c
8870 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8871 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8872 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8873 key for this.
8874 @c
8875 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8876 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8877 @c
8878 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8879 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8880 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8881 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8882 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8883 @c
8884 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8885 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8886 @c
8887 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8888 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8889 @c
8890 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8891 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8892 @c
8893 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8894 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8895 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8896 it to today.@*
8897 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8898 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8899 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8900 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8901 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8902 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8903 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8904 @c
8905 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8906 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8907 into the past.
8908 @c
8909 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8910 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8911 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8912 @c
8913 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8914 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8915 is stopped first.
8916 @c
8917 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8918 Stop the previously started clock.
8919 @c
8920 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8921 Cancel the currently running clock.
8922 @c
8923 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8924 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8925 @c
8926 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8927 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8928 the capture template. See @code{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8929 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8930 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8931 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8932
8933 @tsubheading{Dragging agenda lines forward/backward}
8934 @cindex dragging, agenda lines
8935
8936 @orgcmd{M-<up>,org-agenda-drag-line-backward}
8937 Drag the line at point backward one line@footnote{Moving agenda lines does
8938 not persist after an agenda refresh and does not modify the contributing
8939 @file{.org} files}. With a numeric prefix argument, drag backward by that
8940 many lines.
8941
8942 @orgcmd{M-<down>,org-agenda-drag-line-forward}
8943 Drag the line at point forward one line. With a numeric prefix argument,
8944 drag forward by that many lines.
8945
8946 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8947 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8948 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8949
8950 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8951 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With numeric prefix argument, mark
8952 that many successive entries.
8953 @c
8954 @orgcmd{*,org-agenda-bulk-mark-all}
8955 Mark all visible agenda entries for bulk action.
8956 @c
8957 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8958 Unmark entry at point for bulk action.
8959 @c
8960 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8961 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8962 @c
8963 @orgcmd{M-m,org-agenda-bulk-toggle}
8964 Toggle mark of the entry at point for bulk action.
8965 @c
8966 @orgcmd{M-*,org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all}
8967 Toggle marks of all visible entries for bulk action.
8968 @c
8969 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8970 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8971 @c
8972 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8973 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8974 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8975 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8976 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8977 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8978 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8979
8980 @table @kbd
8981 @item *
8982 Toggle persistent marks.
8983 @item $
8984 Archive all selected entries.
8985 @item A
8986 Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.
8987 @item t
8988 Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and changes the
8989 state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and suppressing logging
8990 notes (but not timestamps).
8991 @item +
8992 Add a tag to all selected entries.
8993 @item -
8994 Remove a tag from all selected entries.
8995 @item s
8996 Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates by a
8997 fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus at the prompt,
8998 for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.
8999 @item d
9000 Set deadline to a specific date.
9001 @item r
9002 Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries will no
9003 longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.
9004 @item S
9005 Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for. With
9006 prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.
9007 @item f
9008 Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions
9009 through @code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries. For
9010 example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the entries to web.
9011
9012 @lisp
9013 @group
9014 (defun set-category ()
9015 (interactive "P")
9016 (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)
9017 (org-agenda-error)))
9018 (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))
9019 (with-current-buffer buffer
9020 (save-excursion
9021 (save-restriction
9022 (widen)
9023 (goto-char marker)
9024 (org-back-to-heading t)
9025 (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))
9026 @end group
9027 @end lisp
9028 @end table
9029
9030 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
9031 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
9032
9033 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
9034 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
9035 @c
9036 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
9037 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
9038 date at the cursor.
9039 @c
9040 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
9041 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
9042 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
9043 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
9044 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
9045 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
9046 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
9047 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
9048 you can add the entry.
9049
9050 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
9051 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
9052 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
9053 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
9054 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
9055 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
9056 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
9057 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
9058 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
9059 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
9060 @c
9061 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
9062 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
9063 @c
9064 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
9065 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
9066 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
9067 @c
9068 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
9069 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
9070 calendars.
9071 @c
9072 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
9073 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
9074
9075 @item M-x org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files RET
9076 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
9077 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
9078
9079 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
9080 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
9081 @cindex exporting agenda views
9082 @cindex agenda views, exporting
9083 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
9084 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
9085 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (@file{.html} or @file{.htm}),
9086 Postscript (@file{.ps}), PDF (@file{.pdf}), Org (@file{.org}) and plain text
9087 (any other extension). When exporting to Org, only the body of original
9088 headlines are exported, not subtrees or inherited tags. When called with a
9089 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the
9090 variable @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for
9091 @file{ps-print} and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
9092
9093 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
9094 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
9095 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
9096 @c
9097 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
9098 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
9099 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
9100 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
9101 visit Org files will not be removed.
9102 @end table
9103
9104
9105 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
9106 @section Custom agenda views
9107 @cindex custom agenda views
9108 @cindex agenda views, custom
9109
9110 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
9111 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
9112 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
9113 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
9114
9115 @menu
9116 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
9117 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
9118 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
9119 @end menu
9120
9121 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
9122 @subsection Storing searches
9123
9124 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
9125 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
9126 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
9127 buffer).
9128 @kindex C-c a C
9129 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
9130 @cindex agenda views, main example
9131 @cindex agenda, as an agenda views
9132 @cindex agenda*, as an agenda views
9133 @cindex tags, as an agenda view
9134 @cindex todo, as an agenda view
9135 @cindex tags-todo
9136 @cindex todo-tree
9137 @cindex occur-tree
9138 @cindex tags-tree
9139
9140 Custom commands are configured in the variable
9141 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
9142 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
9143 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid agenda
9144 views:
9145
9146 @lisp
9147 @group
9148 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9149 '(("x" agenda)
9150 ("y" agenda*)
9151 ("w" todo "WAITING")
9152 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
9153 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
9154 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
9155 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
9156 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
9157 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
9158 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
9159 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
9160 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
9161 @end group
9162 @end lisp
9163
9164 @noindent
9165 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
9166 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
9167 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
9168 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
9169 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
9170 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
9171 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
9172 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
9173 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
9174 therefore define:
9175
9176 @table @kbd
9177 @item C-c a x
9178 as a global search for agenda entries planned@footnote{@emph{Planned} means
9179 here that these entries have some planning information attached to them, like
9180 a time-stamp, a scheduled or a deadline string. See
9181 @code{org-agenda-entry-types} on how to set what planning information will be
9182 taken into account.} this week/day.
9183 @item C-c a y
9184 as a global search for agenda entries planned this week/day, but only those
9185 with an hour specification like @code{[h]h:mm}---think of them as appointments.
9186 @item C-c a w
9187 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
9188 keyword
9189 @item C-c a W
9190 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
9191 results as a sparse tree
9192 @item C-c a u
9193 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
9194 @samp{:urgent:}
9195 @item C-c a v
9196 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
9197 headlines that are also TODO items
9198 @item C-c a U
9199 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
9200 displaying the result as a sparse tree
9201 @item C-c a f
9202 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
9203 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
9204 @item C-c a h
9205 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
9206 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
9207 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
9208 @end table
9209
9210 Note that the @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an
9211 Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only.
9212
9213 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
9214 @subsection Block agenda
9215 @cindex block agenda
9216 @cindex agenda, with block views
9217
9218 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
9219 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
9220 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
9221 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
9222 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
9223 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
9224 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
9225
9226 @lisp
9227 @group
9228 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9229 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
9230 ((agenda "")
9231 (tags-todo "home")
9232 (tags "garden")))
9233 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
9234 ((agenda "")
9235 (tags-todo "work")
9236 (tags "office")))))
9237 @end group
9238 @end lisp
9239
9240 @noindent
9241 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
9242 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
9243 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
9244 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
9245 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
9246
9247 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
9248 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
9249 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
9250
9251 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
9252 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
9253 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
9254 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
9255 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
9256 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
9257 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
9258
9259 @lisp
9260 @group
9261 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9262 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
9263 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
9264 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
9265 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
9266 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
9267 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
9268 ("N" search ""
9269 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
9270 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
9271 @end group
9272 @end lisp
9273
9274 @noindent
9275 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
9276 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
9277 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
9278 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
9279 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
9280 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
9281 to only a single file.
9282
9283 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
9284 For command sets creating a block agenda,
9285 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
9286 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
9287 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
9288 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
9289 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
9290 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
9291 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
9292 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
9293 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
9294
9295 @lisp
9296 @group
9297 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9298 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
9299 ((agenda)
9300 (tags-todo "home")
9301 (tags "garden"
9302 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
9303 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
9304 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
9305 ((agenda)
9306 (tags-todo "work")
9307 (tags "office")))))
9308 @end group
9309 @end lisp
9310
9311 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
9312 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
9313 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
9314 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
9315 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
9316 yourself.
9317
9318 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
9319 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
9320 context, you can customize @code{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
9321 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
9322 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
9323 like this:
9324
9325 @lisp
9326 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
9327 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
9328 @end lisp
9329
9330 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
9331 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
9332
9333 @lisp
9334 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
9335 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
9336 @end lisp
9337
9338 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
9339
9340 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
9341 @section Exporting Agenda Views
9342 @cindex agenda views, exporting
9343
9344 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
9345 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
9346 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
9347 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
9348 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
9349 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
9350 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
9351
9352 @table @kbd
9353 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
9354 @cindex exporting agenda views
9355 @cindex agenda views, exporting
9356 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
9357 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
9358 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
9359 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
9360 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
9361 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
9362 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
9363
9364 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
9365 @vindex htmlize-output-type
9366 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
9367 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
9368 @lisp
9369 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
9370 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
9371 (ps-landscape-mode t)
9372 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
9373 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
9374 @end lisp
9375 @end table
9376
9377 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
9378 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
9379 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
9380 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
9381 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
9382 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
9383 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
9384 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
9385 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
9386 or absolute.
9387
9388 @lisp
9389 @group
9390 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9391 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
9392 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
9393 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
9394 ((agenda "")
9395 (tags-todo "home")
9396 (tags "garden"))
9397 nil
9398 ("~/views/home.html"))
9399 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
9400 ((agenda)
9401 (tags-todo "work")
9402 (tags "office"))
9403 nil
9404 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
9405 @end group
9406 @end lisp
9407
9408 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
9409 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
9410 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
9411 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
9412 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
9413 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
9414 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
9415 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
9416
9417 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
9418 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
9419 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
9420 files in one step:
9421
9422 @table @kbd
9423 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
9424 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
9425 them.
9426 @end table
9427
9428 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
9429 set options for the export commands. For example:
9430
9431 @lisp
9432 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9433 '(("X" agenda ""
9434 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
9435 (ps-landscape-mode t)
9436 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
9437 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
9438 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
9439 ("theagenda.ps"))))
9440 @end lisp
9441
9442 @noindent
9443 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
9444 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
9445 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
9446 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
9447 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
9448 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
9449 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
9450 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
9451 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
9452
9453 @noindent
9454 From the command line you may also use
9455 @example
9456 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
9457 @end example
9458 @noindent
9459 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
9460 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
9461 @example
9462 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
9463 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
9464 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
9465 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
9466 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
9467 -kill
9468 @end example
9469 @noindent
9470 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
9471 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
9472 extent.
9473
9474 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
9475 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
9476 more information.
9477
9478
9479 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
9480 @section Using column view in the agenda
9481 @cindex column view, in agenda
9482 @cindex agenda, column view
9483
9484 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
9485 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
9486 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
9487 collected by certain criteria.
9488
9489 @table @kbd
9490 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
9491 Turn on column view in the agenda.
9492 @end table
9493
9494 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
9495 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
9496 This causes the following issues:
9497
9498 @enumerate
9499 @item
9500 @vindex org-columns-default-format
9501 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
9502 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
9503 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
9504 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
9505 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
9506 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
9507 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
9508 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
9509 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
9510 @item
9511 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
9512 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
9513 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
9514 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
9515 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
9516 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
9517 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
9518 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
9519 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
9520 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
9521 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
9522 some values will count double.
9523 @item
9524 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
9525 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
9526 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9527 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9528 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9529 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9530 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9531 the agenda).
9532
9533 @item
9534 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9535 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9536 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9537 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9538 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9539 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9540 @end enumerate
9541
9542
9543 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9544 @chapter Markup for rich export
9545
9546 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9547 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. Since
9548 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{} allow much richer formatting, Org mode has
9549 rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section summarizes the
9550 markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9551
9552 @menu
9553 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9554 * Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism
9555 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9556 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9557 * Index entries:: Making an index
9558 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates
9559 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9560 * Special blocks:: Containers targeted at export back-ends
9561 @end menu
9562
9563 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9564 @section Structural markup elements
9565
9566 @menu
9567 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9568 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9569 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9570 * Lists:: Lists
9571 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9572 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9573 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9574 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9575 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9576 @end menu
9577
9578 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9579 @subheading Document title
9580 @cindex document title, markup rules
9581
9582 @noindent
9583 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9584
9585 @cindex #+TITLE
9586 @example
9587 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9588 @end example
9589
9590 @noindent
9591 If this line does not exist, the title will be the name of the file
9592 associated to buffer, without extension, or the buffer name.
9593
9594 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9595 If you are exporting only a subtree, its heading will become the title of the
9596 document. If the subtree has a property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take
9597 precedence.
9598
9599 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9600 @subheading Headings and sections
9601 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9602
9603 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9604 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9605 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9606 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9607 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9608 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9609 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9610 per-file basis with a line
9611
9612 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9613 @example
9614 #+OPTIONS: H:4
9615 @end example
9616
9617 @node Table of contents, Lists, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9618 @subheading Table of contents
9619 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9620
9621 @cindex #+TOC
9622 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9623 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9624 of the file. The depth of the table is by default the same as the number of
9625 headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off the table
9626 of contents entirely, by configuring the variable @code{org-export-with-toc},
9627 or on a per-file basis with a line like
9628
9629 @example
9630 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9631 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no default TOC at all)
9632 @end example
9633
9634 If you would like to move the table of contents to a different location, you
9635 should turn off the default table using @code{org-export-with-toc} or
9636 @code{#+OPTIONS} and insert @code{#+TOC: headlines N} at the desired
9637 location(s).
9638
9639 @example
9640 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no default TOC)
9641 ...
9642 #+TOC: headlines 2 (insert TOC here, with two headline levels)
9643 @end example
9644
9645 Multiple @code{#+TOC: headline} lines are allowed. The same @code{TOC}
9646 keyword can also generate a list of all tables (resp.@: all listings) with a
9647 caption in the buffer.
9648
9649 @example
9650 #+TOC: listings (build a list of listings)
9651 #+TOC: tables (build a list of tables)
9652 @end example
9653
9654 @cindex property, ALT_TITLE
9655 The headline's title usually determines its corresponding entry in a table of
9656 contents. However, it is possible to specify an alternative title by
9657 setting @code{ALT_TITLE} property accordingly. It will then be used when
9658 building the table.
9659
9660 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9661 @subheading Lists
9662 @cindex lists, markup rules
9663
9664 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the back-end's
9665 syntax for such lists. Most back-ends support unordered, ordered, and
9666 description lists.
9667
9668 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9669 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9670 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9671
9672 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9673 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9674
9675 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9676 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9677
9678 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9679 @example
9680 #+BEGIN_VERSE
9681 Great clouds overhead
9682 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9683 Snow covers Emacs
9684
9685 -- AlexSchroeder
9686 #+END_VERSE
9687 @end example
9688
9689 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9690 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9691 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9692
9693 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9694 @example
9695 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9696 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9697 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9698 #+END_QUOTE
9699 @end example
9700
9701 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9702 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9703 @example
9704 #+BEGIN_CENTER
9705 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9706 but not any simpler
9707 #+END_CENTER
9708 @end example
9709
9710
9711 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9712 @subheading Footnote markup
9713 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9714 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9715
9716 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9717 by all back-ends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9718 multiple footnotes side by side.
9719
9720 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9721 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9722
9723 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9724 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9725 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9726 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9727 @cindex code text, markup rules
9728 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9729 @vindex org-fontify-emphasized-text
9730 @vindex org-emphasis-regexp-components
9731 @vindex org-emphasis-alist
9732 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9733 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9734 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9735 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
9736
9737 To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set
9738 @code{org-fontify-emphasized-text} to @code{nil}. To narrow down the list of
9739 available markup syntax, you can customize @code{org-emphasis-alist}. To fine
9740 tune what characters are allowed before and after the markup characters, you
9741 can tweak @code{org-emphasis-regexp-components}. Beware that changing one of
9742 the above variables will no take effect until you reload Org, for which you
9743 may need to restart Emacs.
9744
9745 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9746 @subheading Horizontal rules
9747 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9748 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9749 a horizontal line.
9750
9751 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9752 @subheading Comment lines
9753 @cindex comment lines
9754 @cindex exporting, not
9755 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9756
9757 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9758 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9759 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9760 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9761 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9762
9763 @table @kbd
9764 @kindex C-c ;
9765 @item C-c ;
9766 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9767 @end table
9768
9769
9770 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9771 @section Images and Tables
9772
9773 @cindex tables, markup rules
9774 @cindex #+CAPTION
9775 @cindex #+NAME
9776 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9777 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9778 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9779 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9780 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9781 the object with @code{[[tab:basic-data]]} (@pxref{Internal links}):
9782
9783 @example
9784 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9785 #+NAME: tab:basic-data
9786 | ... | ...|
9787 |-----|----|
9788 @end example
9789
9790 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9791 @example
9792 #+CAPTION[Caption for list of tables]: Caption for table.
9793 @end example
9794
9795 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9796 Some back-ends allow you to directly include images into the exported
9797 document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have
9798 a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}. If you wish to
9799 define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross
9800 references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede it
9801 with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+NAME} as follows:
9802
9803 @example
9804 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9805 #+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049
9806 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9807 @end example
9808
9809 @noindent
9810 Such images can be displayed within the buffer. @xref{Handling links,the
9811 discussion of image links}.
9812
9813 Even though images and tables are prominent examples of captioned structures,
9814 the same caption mechanism can apply to many others (e.g., @LaTeX{}
9815 equations, source code blocks). Depending on the export back-end, those may
9816 or may not be handled.
9817
9818 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9819 @section Literal examples
9820 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9821 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9822
9823 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9824 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9825 for source code and similar examples.
9826 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9827
9828 @example
9829 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9830 Some example from a text file.
9831 #+END_EXAMPLE
9832 @end example
9833
9834 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9835 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9836 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9837 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9838 whitespace before the colon:
9839
9840 @example
9841 Here is an example
9842 : Some example from a text file.
9843 @end example
9844
9845 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9846 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9847 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9848 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9849 the HTML back-end (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9850 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9851 achieved using either the listings or the
9852 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9853 @code{org-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9854 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9855 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9856 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9857 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9858 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9859 blocks.
9860 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
9861
9862 @example
9863 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9864 (defun org-xor (a b)
9865 "Exclusive or."
9866 (if a (not b) b))
9867 #+END_SRC
9868 @end example
9869
9870 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9871 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9872 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9873 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9874 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9875 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9876 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9877 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9878 cool.
9879
9880 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9881 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9882 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9883 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9884 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9885 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9886 Here is an example:
9887
9888 @example
9889 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9890 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9891 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9892 #+END_SRC
9893 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9894 jumps to point-min.
9895 @end example
9896
9897 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9898 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9899 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9900 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9901
9902 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9903 areas in HTML export}).
9904
9905 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9906 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9907 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9908
9909 @table @kbd
9910 @kindex C-c '
9911 @item C-c '
9912 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9913 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9914 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9915 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9916 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9917 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9918 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9919 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9920 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9921 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9922 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9923 will create a new fixed-width region.
9924 @kindex C-c l
9925 @item C-c l
9926 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9927 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9928 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9929 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9930 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9931 @end table
9932
9933
9934 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9935 @section Include files
9936 @cindex include files, markup rules
9937
9938 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9939 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9940 @cindex #+INCLUDE
9941
9942 @example
9943 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9944 @end example
9945
9946 @noindent
9947 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9948 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9949 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9950 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9951 processed normally.
9952
9953 Contents of the included file will belong to the same structure (headline,
9954 item) containing the @code{INCLUDE} keyword. In particular, headlines within
9955 the file will become children of the current section. That behaviour can be
9956 changed by providing an additional keyword parameter, @code{:minlevel}. In
9957 that case, all headlines in the included file will be shifted so the one with
9958 the lowest level reaches that specified level. For example, to make a file
9959 become a sibling of the current top-level headline, use
9960
9961 @example
9962 #+INCLUDE: "~/my-book/chapter2.org" :minlevel 1
9963 @end example
9964
9965 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9966 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9967 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9968 obvious defaults.
9969
9970 @example
9971 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9972 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9973 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9974 @end example
9975
9976 @table @kbd
9977 @kindex C-c '
9978 @item C-c '
9979 Visit the include file at point.
9980 @end table
9981
9982 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9983 @section Index entries
9984 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9985
9986 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9987 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9988 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9989 an index} for more information.
9990
9991 @example
9992 * Curriculum Vitae
9993 #+INDEX: CV
9994 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9995 @end example
9996
9997
9998
9999
10000 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
10001 @section Macro replacement
10002 @cindex macro replacement, during export
10003 @cindex #+MACRO
10004
10005 You can define text snippets with
10006
10007 @example
10008 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
10009 @end example
10010
10011 @noindent which can be referenced in
10012 paragraphs, verse blocks, table cells and some keywords with
10013 @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}@footnote{Since commas separate arguments,
10014 commas within arguments have to be escaped with a backslash character.
10015 Conversely, backslash characters before a comma, and only them, need to be
10016 escaped with another backslash character.}. In addition to defined macros,
10017 @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc., will reference
10018 information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and similar lines.
10019 Also, @code{@{@{@{time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
10020 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
10021 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
10022 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
10023 @code{format-time-string}.
10024
10025 Macro expansion takes place during export.
10026
10027
10028 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, Special blocks, Macro replacement, Markup
10029 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
10030 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
10031 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
10032
10033 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
10034 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
10035 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
10036 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
10037 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
10038 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
10039 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
10040 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
10041 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export back-ends.
10042
10043 @menu
10044 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
10045 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
10046 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
10047 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
10048 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
10049 @end menu
10050
10051 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
10052 @subsection Special symbols
10053 @cindex math symbols
10054 @cindex special symbols
10055 @cindex @TeX{} macros
10056 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
10057 @cindex HTML entities
10058 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
10059
10060 You can use @LaTeX{}-like syntax to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha}
10061 to indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
10062 for these symbols is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
10063 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
10064 code, Org mode allows these symbols to be present without surrounding math
10065 delimiters, for example:
10066
10067 @example
10068 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
10069 @end example
10070
10071 @vindex org-entities
10072 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
10073 the exporter back-end. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
10074 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
10075 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
10076 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
10077 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
10078
10079 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
10080 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
10081 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
10082 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
10083 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
10084
10085 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF-8 characters, use the
10086 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
10087 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
10088 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
10089
10090 @table @kbd
10091 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
10092 @kindex C-c C-x \
10093 @item C-c C-x \
10094 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
10095 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
10096 for display purposes only.
10097 @end table
10098
10099 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
10100 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
10101 @cindex subscript
10102 @cindex superscript
10103
10104 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super- and
10105 subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in math-mode
10106 delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is not necessary
10107 (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts with curly braces.
10108 For example
10109
10110 @example
10111 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
10112 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
10113 @end example
10114
10115 @vindex org-use-sub-superscripts
10116 If you write a text where the underscore is often used in a different
10117 context, Org's convention to always interpret these as subscripts can get in
10118 your way. Configure the variable @code{org-use-sub-superscripts} to change
10119 this convention. For example, when setting this variable to @code{@{@}},
10120 @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
10121
10122 @table @kbd
10123 @kindex C-c C-x \
10124 @item C-c C-x \
10125 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
10126 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
10127 @end table
10128
10129 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
10130 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
10131 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
10132
10133 @vindex org-format-latex-header
10134 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
10135 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
10136 to process these for several export back-ends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
10137 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
10138 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
10139 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
10140 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
10141 @file{MathJax} on your own server in order to limit the load of our server.}.
10142 Finally, it can also process the mathematical expressions into
10143 images@footnote{For this to work you need to be on a system with a working
10144 @LaTeX{} installation. You also need the @file{dvipng} program or the
10145 @file{convert}, respectively available at
10146 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the @file{imagemagick}
10147 suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when processing a fragment can
10148 be configured with the variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be
10149 displayed in a browser.
10150
10151 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
10152 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
10153 @itemize @bullet
10154 @item
10155 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
10156 environments recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
10157 @file{dvipng} program or @file{imagemagick} suite is used to create images,
10158 any @LaTeX{} environment will be handled.}. The only requirement is that the
10159 @code{\begin} and @code{\end} statements appear on a new line, at the
10160 beginning of the line or after whitespaces only.
10161 @item
10162 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
10163 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
10164 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
10165 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
10166 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
10167 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
10168 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
10169 @end itemize
10170
10171 @noindent For example:
10172
10173 @example
10174 \begin@{equation@}
10175 x=\sqrt@{b@}
10176 \end@{equation@}
10177
10178 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
10179 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
10180 @end example
10181
10182 @c FIXME
10183 @c @noindent
10184 @c @vindex org-format-latex-options
10185 @c If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
10186 @c can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
10187 @c ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
10188
10189 @vindex org-export-with-latex
10190 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
10191 @code{org-export-with-latex}. The default setting is @code{t} which means
10192 @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for ASCII and @LaTeX{} back-ends.
10193 You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one of these
10194 lines:
10195
10196 @example
10197 #+OPTIONS: tex:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
10198 #+OPTIONS: tex:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
10199 #+OPTIONS: tex:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
10200 @end example
10201
10202 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
10203 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
10204 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
10205
10206 @vindex org-latex-create-formula-image-program
10207 If you have @file{dvipng} or @file{imagemagick} installed@footnote{Choose the
10208 converter by setting the variable
10209 @code{org-latex-create-formula-image-program} accordingly.}, @LaTeX{}
10210 fragments can be processed to produce preview images of the typeset
10211 expressions:
10212
10213 @table @kbd
10214 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
10215 @item C-c C-x C-l
10216 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
10217 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
10218 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
10219 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
10220 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
10221 process the entire buffer.
10222 @kindex C-c C-c
10223 @item C-c C-c
10224 Remove the overlay preview images.
10225 @end table
10226
10227 @vindex org-format-latex-options
10228 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
10229 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
10230 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
10231 preview images.
10232
10233 @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview
10234 You can turn on the previewing of all @LaTeX{} fragments in a file with
10235
10236 @example
10237 #+STARTUP: latexpreview
10238 @end example
10239
10240 To disable it, simply use
10241
10242 @example
10243 #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview
10244 @end example
10245
10246 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
10247 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
10248 @cindex CD@LaTeX{}
10249
10250 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
10251 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
10252 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
10253 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
10254 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
10255 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
10256 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
10257 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
10258 on for the current buffer with @kbd{M-x org-cdlatex-mode RET}, or for all
10259 Org files with
10260
10261 @lisp
10262 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
10263 @end lisp
10264
10265 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
10266 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
10267 @itemize @bullet
10268 @kindex C-c @{
10269 @item
10270 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
10271 @item
10272 @kindex @key{TAB}
10273 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
10274 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
10275 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
10276 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
10277 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
10278 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
10279 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
10280 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
10281 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
10282 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
10283 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help RET}.
10284 @item
10285 @kindex _
10286 @kindex ^
10287 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
10288 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
10289 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
10290 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
10291 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
10292 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
10293 @item
10294 @kindex `
10295 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
10296 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
10297 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
10298 @item
10299 @kindex '
10300 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
10301 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
10302 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
10303 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
10304 is normal.
10305 @end itemize
10306
10307 @node Special blocks, , Embedded @LaTeX{}, Markup
10308 @section Special blocks
10309 @cindex Special blocks
10310
10311 Org syntax includes pre-defined blocks (@pxref{Paragraphs} and @ref{Literal
10312 examples}). It is also possible to create blocks containing raw code
10313 targeted at a specific back-ends (e.g., @samp{#+BEGIN_LATEX}).
10314
10315 Any other block is a @emph{special block}. Each export back-end decides if
10316 they should be exported, and how. When the block is ignored, its contents
10317 are still exported, as if the block were not there. For example, when
10318 exporting a @samp{#+BEGIN_TEST} block, HTML back-end wraps its contents
10319 within @samp{<div name="test">} tag. Refer to back-end specific
10320 documentation for more information.
10321
10322 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
10323 @chapter Exporting
10324 @cindex exporting
10325
10326 The Org mode export facilities can be used to export Org documents or parts
10327 of Org documents to a variety of other formats. In addition, these
10328 facilities can be used with @code{orgtbl-mode} and/or @code{orgstruct-mode}
10329 in foreign buffers so you can author tables and lists in Org syntax and
10330 convert them in place to the target language.
10331
10332 ASCII export produces a readable and simple version of an Org file for
10333 printing and sharing notes. HTML export allows you to easily publish notes
10334 on the web, or to build full-fledged websites. @LaTeX{} export lets you use
10335 Org mode and its structured editing functions to create arbitrarily complex
10336 @LaTeX{} files for any kind of document. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export
10337 allows seamless collaboration across organizational boundaries. Markdown
10338 export lets you seamlessly collaborate with other developers. Finally, iCal
10339 export can extract entries with deadlines or appointments to produce a file
10340 in the iCalendar format.
10341
10342 @menu
10343 * The Export Dispatcher:: The main exporter interface
10344 * Export back-ends:: Built-in export formats
10345 * Export settings:: Generic export settings
10346 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
10347 * Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation
10348 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
10349 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
10350 * Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown
10351 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
10352 * iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar
10353 * Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to @code{Texinfo}, a man page, or Org
10354 * Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables in lists in Org syntax
10355 * Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output
10356 @end menu
10357
10358 @node The Export Dispatcher, Export back-ends, Exporting, Exporting
10359 @section The Export Dispatcher
10360 @vindex org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui
10361 @cindex Export, dispatcher
10362
10363 The main entry point for export related tasks is the dispatcher, a
10364 hierarchical menu from which it is possible to select an export format and
10365 toggle export options@footnote{It is also possible to use a less intrusive
10366 interface by setting @code{org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui} to a
10367 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, only a prompt is visible from the
10368 minibuffer. From there one can still switch back to regular menu by pressing
10369 @key{?}.} from which it is possible to select an export format and to toggle
10370 export options.
10371
10372 @c @quotation
10373 @table @asis
10374 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export-dispatch}
10375
10376 Dispatch for export and publishing commands. When called with a @kbd{C-u}
10377 prefix argument, repeat the last export command on the current buffer while
10378 preserving toggled options. If the current buffer hasn't changed and subtree
10379 export was activated, the command will affect that same subtree.
10380 @end table
10381 @c @end quotation
10382
10383 Normally the entire buffer is exported, but if there is an active region
10384 only that part of the buffer will be exported.
10385
10386 Several export options (@pxref{Export settings}) can be toggled from the
10387 export dispatcher with the following key combinations:
10388
10389 @table @kbd
10390 @item C-a
10391 @vindex org-export-async-init-file
10392 Toggle asynchronous export. Asynchronous export uses an external Emacs
10393 process that is configured with a specified initialization file.
10394
10395 While exporting asynchronously, the output is not displayed. It is stored in
10396 a list called ``the export stack'', and can be viewed from there. The stack
10397 can be reached by calling the dispatcher with a double @kbd{C-u} prefix
10398 argument, or with @kbd{&} key from the dispatcher.
10399
10400 @vindex org-export-in-background
10401 To make this behaviour the default, customize the variable
10402 @code{org-export-in-background}.
10403
10404 @item C-b
10405 Toggle body-only export. Its effect depends on the back-end used.
10406 Typically, if the back-end has a header section (like @code{<head>...</head>}
10407 in the HTML back-end), a body-only export will not include this header.
10408
10409 @item C-s
10410 @vindex org-export-initial-scope
10411 Toggle subtree export. The top heading becomes the document title.
10412
10413 You can change the default state of this option by setting
10414 @code{org-export-initial-scope}.
10415
10416 @item C-v
10417 Toggle visible-only export. Only export the text that is currently
10418 visible, i.e. not hidden by outline visibility in the buffer.
10419
10420 @end table
10421
10422 @vindex org-export-copy-to-kill-ring
10423 With the exception of asynchronous export, a successful export process writes
10424 its output to the kill-ring. You can configure this behavior by altering the
10425 option @code{org-export-copy-to-kill-ring}.
10426
10427 @node Export back-ends, Export settings, The Export Dispatcher, Exporting
10428 @section Export back-ends
10429 @cindex Export, back-ends
10430
10431 An export back-end is a library that translates Org syntax into a foreign
10432 format. An export format is not available until the proper back-end has been
10433 loaded.
10434
10435 @vindex org-export-backends
10436 By default, the following four back-ends are loaded: @code{ascii},
10437 @code{html}, @code{icalendar} and @code{latex}. It is possible to add more
10438 (or remove some) by customizing @code{org-export-backends}.
10439
10440 Built-in back-ends include:
10441
10442 @itemize
10443 @item ascii (ASCII format)
10444 @item beamer (@LaTeX{} Beamer format)
10445 @item html (HTML format)
10446 @item icalendar (iCalendar format)
10447 @item latex (@LaTeX{} format)
10448 @item man (Man page format)
10449 @item md (Markdown format)
10450 @item odt (OpenDocument Text format)
10451 @item texinfo (Texinfo format)
10452 @end itemize
10453
10454 Other back-ends might be found in the @code{contrib/} directory
10455 (@pxref{Installation}).
10456
10457 @node Export settings, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export back-ends, Exporting
10458 @section Export settings
10459 @cindex Export, settings
10460
10461 Export options can be set: globally with variables; for an individual file by
10462 making variables buffer-local with in-buffer settings (@pxref{In-buffer
10463 settings}), by setting individual keywords, or by specifying them in a
10464 compact form with the @code{#+OPTIONS} keyword; or for a tree by setting
10465 properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}). Options set at a specific level
10466 override options set at a more general level.
10467
10468 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
10469 In-buffer settings may appear anywhere in the file, either directly or
10470 indirectly through a file included using @samp{#+SETUPFILE: filename} syntax.
10471 Option keyword sets tailored to a particular back-end can be inserted from
10472 the export dispatcher (@pxref{The Export Dispatcher}) using the @code{Insert
10473 template} command by pressing @key{#}. To insert keywords individually,
10474 a good way to make sure the keyword is correct is to type @code{#+} and then
10475 to use @kbd{M-<TAB>} for completion.
10476
10477 The export keywords available for every back-end, and their equivalent global
10478 variables, include:
10479
10480 @table @samp
10481 @item AUTHOR
10482 @vindex user-full-name
10483 The document author (@code{user-full-name}).
10484
10485 @item CREATOR
10486 @vindex org-export-creator-string
10487 Entity responsible for output generation (@code{org-export-creator-string}).
10488
10489 @item DATE
10490 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
10491 A date or a time-stamp@footnote{The variable
10492 @code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this time-stamp will be
10493 exported.}.
10494
10495 @item DESCRIPTION
10496 The document description. Back-ends handle it as they see fit (e.g., for the
10497 XHTML meta tag), if at all. You can use several such keywords for long
10498 descriptions.
10499
10500 @item EMAIL
10501 @vindex user-mail-address
10502 The email address (@code{user-mail-address}).
10503
10504 @item KEYWORDS
10505 The keywords defining the contents of the document. Back-ends handle it as
10506 they see fit (e.g., for the XHTML meta tag), if at all. You can use several
10507 such keywords if the list is long.
10508
10509 @item LANGUAGE
10510 @vindex org-export-default-language
10511 The language used for translating some strings
10512 (@code{org-export-default-language}). E.g., @samp{#+LANGUAGE: fr} will tell
10513 Org to translate @emph{File} (english) into @emph{Fichier} (french) in the
10514 clocktable.
10515
10516 @item SELECT_TAGS
10517 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10518 The tags that select a tree for export (@code{org-export-select-tags}). The
10519 default value is @code{:export:}. Within a subtree tagged with
10520 @code{:export:}, you can still exclude entries with @code{:noexport:} (see
10521 below). When headlines are selectively exported with @code{:export:}
10522 anywhere in a file, text before the first headline is ignored.
10523
10524 @item EXCLUDE_TAGS
10525 The tags that exclude a tree from export (@code{org-export-exclude-tags}).
10526 The default value is @code{:noexport:}. Entries with the @code{:noexport:}
10527 tag will be unconditionally excluded from the export, even if they have an
10528 @code{:export:} tag.
10529
10530 @item TITLE
10531 The title to be shown (otherwise derived from buffer's name). You can use
10532 several such keywords for long titles.
10533 @end table
10534
10535 The @code{#+OPTIONS} keyword is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure
10536 many options this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form that
10537 recognizes the following arguments:
10538
10539 @table @code
10540 @item ':
10541 @vindex org-export-with-smart-quotes
10542 Toggle smart quotes (@code{org-export-with-smart-quotes}).
10543
10544 @item *:
10545 Toggle emphasized text (@code{org-export-with-emphasize}).
10546
10547 @item -:
10548 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10549 Toggle conversion of special strings
10550 (@code{org-export-with-special-strings}).
10551
10552 @item ::
10553 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10554 Toggle fixed-width sections
10555 (@code{org-export-with-fixed-width}).
10556
10557 @item <:
10558 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10559 Toggle inclusion of any time/date active/inactive stamps
10560 (@code{org-export-with-timestamps}).
10561
10562 @item :
10563 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10564 Toggle line-break-preservation (@code{org-export-preserve-breaks}).
10565
10566 @item ^:
10567 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10568 Toggle @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If you write "^:@{@}",
10569 @samp{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but the simple @samp{a_b} will be left as
10570 it is (@code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}).
10571
10572 @item arch:
10573 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10574 Configure export of archived trees. Can be set to @code{headline} to only
10575 process the headline, skipping its contents
10576 (@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}).
10577
10578 @item author:
10579 @vindex org-export-with-author
10580 Toggle inclusion of author name into exported file
10581 (@code{org-export-with-author}).
10582
10583 @item c:
10584 @vindex org-export-with-clocks
10585 Toggle inclusion of CLOCK keywords (@code{org-export-with-clocks}).
10586
10587 @item creator:
10588 @vindex org-export-with-creator
10589 Configure inclusion of creator info into exported file. It may be set to
10590 @code{comment} (@code{org-export-with-creator}).
10591
10592 @item d:
10593 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10594 Toggle inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include
10595 (@code{org-export-with-drawers}).
10596
10597 @item e:
10598 @vindex org-export-with-entities
10599 Toggle inclusion of entities (@code{org-export-with-entities}).
10600
10601 @item email:
10602 @vindex org-export-with-email
10603 Toggle inclusion of the author's e-mail into exported file
10604 (@code{org-export-with-email}).
10605
10606 @item f:
10607 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10608 Toggle the inclusion of footnotes (@code{org-export-with-footnotes}).
10609
10610 @item H:
10611 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10612 Set the number of headline levels for export
10613 (@code{org-export-headline-levels}). Below that level, headlines are treated
10614 differently. In most back-ends, they become list items.
10615
10616 @item inline:
10617 @vindex org-export-with-inlinetasks
10618 Toggle inclusion of inlinetasks (@code{org-export-with-inlinetasks}).
10619
10620 @item num:
10621 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10622 Toggle section-numbers (@code{org-export-with-section-numbers}). It can also
10623 be set to a number @samp{n}, so only headlines at that level or above will be
10624 numbered.
10625
10626 @item p:
10627 @vindex org-export-with-planning
10628 Toggle export of planning information (@code{org-export-with-planning}).
10629 ``Planning information'' is the line containing the @code{SCHEDULED:}, the
10630 @code{DEADLINE:} or the @code{CLOSED:} cookies or a combination of them.
10631
10632 @item pri:
10633 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10634 Toggle inclusion of priority cookies (@code{org-export-with-priority}).
10635
10636 @item stat:
10637 @vindex org-export-with-statistics-cookies
10638 Toggle inclusion of statistics cookies
10639 (@code{org-export-with-statistics-cookies}).
10640
10641 @item tags:
10642 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10643 Toggle inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}
10644 (@code{org-export-with-tags}).
10645
10646 @item tasks:
10647 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
10648 Toggle inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be @code{nil} to remove all
10649 tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or a list of keywords to keep
10650 (@code{org-export-with-tasks}).
10651
10652 @item tex:
10653 @vindex org-export-with-latex
10654 Configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments and environments. It may be set to
10655 @code{verbatim} (@code{org-export-with-latex}).
10656
10657 @item timestamp:
10658 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10659 Toggle inclusion of the creation time into exported file
10660 (@code{org-export-time-stamp-file}).
10661
10662 @item toc:
10663 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10664 Toggle inclusion of the table of contents, or set the level limit
10665 (@code{org-export-with-toc}).
10666
10667 @item todo:
10668 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10669 Toggle inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text
10670 (@code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}).
10671
10672 @item |:
10673 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10674 Toggle inclusion of tables (@code{org-export-with-tables}).
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10678 When exporting only a subtree, each of the previous keywords@footnote{With
10679 the exception of @samp{SETUPFILE}.} can be overriden locally by special node
10680 properties. These begin with @samp{EXPORT_}, followed by the name of the
10681 keyword they supplant. For example, @samp{DATE} and @samp{OPTIONS} keywords
10682 become, respectively, @samp{EXPORT_DATE} and @samp{EXPORT_OPTIONS}
10683 properties. Subtree export also supports the self-explicit
10684 @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property@footnote{There is no buffer-wide equivalent
10685 for this property. The file name in this case is derived from the file
10686 associated to the buffer, if possible, or asked to the user otherwise.}.
10687
10688 @cindex #+BIND
10689 @vindex org-export-allow-bind-keywords
10690 If @code{org-export-allow-bind-keywords} is non-@code{nil}, Emacs variables
10691 can become buffer-local during export by using the BIND keyword. Its syntax
10692 is @samp{#+BIND: variable value}. This is particularly useful for in-buffer
10693 settings that cannot be changed using specific keywords.
10694
10695 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Beamer export, Export settings, Exporting
10696 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
10697 @cindex ASCII export
10698 @cindex Latin-1 export
10699 @cindex UTF-8 export
10700
10701 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
10702 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
10703 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
10704
10705 @vindex org-ascii-links-to-notes
10706 Links are exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in the
10707 text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10708 @code{org-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10709
10710 @subheading ASCII export commands
10711
10712 @table @kbd
10713 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t a/l/u,org-ascii-export-to-ascii}
10714 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
10715 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without warning.
10716 When the original file is @file{myfile.txt}, the resulting file becomes
10717 @file{myfile.txt.txt} in order to prevent data loss.
10718 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t A/L/U,org-ascii-export-as-ascii}
10719 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10720 @end table
10721
10722 @subheading Header and sectioning structure
10723
10724 In the exported version, the first three outline levels become headlines,
10725 defining a general document structure. Additional levels are exported as
10726 lists. The transition can also occur at a different level (@pxref{Export
10727 settings}).
10728
10729 @subheading Quoting ASCII text
10730
10731 You can insert text that will only appear when using @code{ASCII} back-end
10732 with the following constructs:
10733
10734 @cindex #+ASCII
10735 @cindex #+BEGIN_ASCII
10736 @example
10737 Text @@@@ascii:and additional text@@@@ within a paragraph.
10738
10739 #+ASCII: Some text
10740
10741 #+BEGIN_ASCII
10742 All lines in this block will appear only when using this back-end.
10743 #+END_ASCII
10744 @end example
10745
10746 @subheading ASCII specific attributes
10747 @cindex #+ATTR_ASCII
10748 @cindex horizontal rules, in ASCII export
10749
10750 @code{ASCII} back-end only understands one attribute, @code{:width}, which
10751 specifies the length, in characters, of a given horizontal rule. It must be
10752 specified using an @code{ATTR_ASCII} line, directly preceding the rule.
10753
10754 @example
10755 #+ATTR_ASCII: :width 10
10756 -----
10757 @end example
10758
10759 @node Beamer export, HTML export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10760 @section Beamer export
10761 @cindex Beamer export
10762
10763 The @LaTeX{} class @emph{Beamer} allows production of high quality
10764 presentations using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special
10765 support for turning an Org mode file or tree into a Beamer presentation.
10766
10767 @subheading Beamer export commands
10768
10769 @table @kbd
10770 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l b,org-beamer-export-to-latex}
10771 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{}
10772 file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will be overwritten without
10773 warning.
10774 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l B,org-beamer-export-as-latex}
10775 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10776 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l P,org-beamer-export-to-pdf}
10777 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10778 @item C-c C-e l O
10779 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10780 @end table
10781
10782 @subheading Sectioning, Frames and Blocks
10783
10784 Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be exportable as
10785 a Beamer presentation. Headlines fall into three categories: sectioning
10786 elements, frames and blocks.
10787
10788 @itemize @minus
10789 @item
10790 @vindex org-beamer-frame-level
10791 Headlines become frames when their level is equal to
10792 @code{org-beamer-frame-level} or @code{H} value in an @code{OPTIONS} line
10793 (@pxref{Export settings}).
10794
10795 @cindex property, BEAMER_ENV
10796 Though, if a headline in the current tree has a @code{BEAMER_ENV} property
10797 set to either to @code{frame} or @code{fullframe}, its level overrides the
10798 variable. A @code{fullframe} is a frame with an empty (ignored) title.
10799
10800 @item
10801 @vindex org-beamer-environments-default
10802 @vindex org-beamer-environments-extra
10803 All frame's children become @code{block} environments. Special block types
10804 can be enforced by setting headline's @code{BEAMER_ENV} property@footnote{If
10805 this property is set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to
10806 make this visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual
10807 aid.} to an appropriate value (see @code{org-beamer-environments-default} for
10808 supported values and @code{org-beamer-environments-extra} for adding more).
10809
10810 @item
10811 @cindex property, BEAMER_REF
10812 As a special case, if the @code{BEAMER_ENV} property is set to either
10813 @code{appendix}, @code{note}, @code{noteNH} or @code{againframe}, the
10814 headline will become, respectively, an appendix, a note (within frame or
10815 between frame, depending on its level), a note with its title ignored or an
10816 @code{\againframe} command. In the latter case, a @code{BEAMER_REF} property
10817 is mandatory in order to refer to the frame being resumed, and contents are
10818 ignored.
10819
10820 Also, a headline with an @code{ignoreheading} environment will have its
10821 contents only inserted in the output. This special value is useful to have
10822 data between frames, or to properly close a @code{column} environment.
10823 @end itemize
10824
10825 @cindex property, BEAMER_ACT
10826 @cindex property, BEAMER_OPT
10827 Headlines also support @code{BEAMER_ACT} and @code{BEAMER_OPT} properties.
10828 The former is translated as an overlay/action specification, or a default
10829 overlay specification when enclosed within square brackets. The latter
10830 specifies options@footnote{The @code{fragile} option is added automatically
10831 if it contains code that requires a verbatim environment, though.} for the
10832 current frame or block. The export back-end will automatically wrap
10833 properties within angular or square brackets when appropriate.
10834
10835 @cindex property, BEAMER_COL
10836 Moreover, headlines handle the @code{BEAMER_COL} property. Its value should
10837 be a decimal number representing the width of the column as a fraction of the
10838 total text width. If the headline has no specific environment, its title
10839 will be ignored and its contents will fill the column created. Otherwise,
10840 the block will fill the whole column and the title will be preserved. Two
10841 contiguous headlines with a non-@code{nil} @code{BEAMER_COL} value share the same
10842 @code{columns} @LaTeX{} environment. It will end before the next headline
10843 without such a property. This environment is generated automatically.
10844 Although, it can also be explicitly created, with a special @code{columns}
10845 value for @code{BEAMER_ENV} property (if it needs to be set up with some
10846 specific options, for example).
10847
10848 @subheading Beamer specific syntax
10849
10850 Beamer back-end is an extension of @LaTeX{} back-end. As such, all @LaTeX{}
10851 specific syntax (e.g., @samp{#+LATEX:} or @samp{#+ATTR_LATEX:}) is
10852 recognized. See @ref{@LaTeX{} and PDF export} for more information.
10853
10854 @cindex #+BEAMER_THEME
10855 @cindex #+BEAMER_COLOR_THEME
10856 @cindex #+BEAMER_FONT_THEME
10857 @cindex #+BEAMER_INNER_THEME
10858 @cindex #+BEAMER_OUTER_THEME
10859 Beamer export introduces a number of keywords to insert code in the
10860 document's header. Four control appearance of the presentation:
10861 @code{#+BEAMER_THEME}, @code{#+BEAMER_COLOR_THEME},
10862 @code{#+BEAMER_FONT_THEME}, @code{#+BEAMER_INNER_THEME} and
10863 @code{#+BEAMER_OUTER_THEME}. All of them accept optional arguments
10864 within square brackets. The last one, @code{#+BEAMER_HEADER}, is more
10865 generic and allows you to append any line of code in the header.
10866
10867 @example
10868 #+BEAMER_THEME: Rochester [height=20pt]
10869 #+BEAMER_COLOR_THEME: spruce
10870 @end example
10871
10872 Table of contents generated from @code{toc:t} @code{OPTION} keyword are
10873 wrapped within a @code{frame} environment. Those generated from a @code{TOC}
10874 keyword (@pxref{Table of contents}) are not. In that case, it is also
10875 possible to specify options, enclosed within square brackets.
10876
10877 @example
10878 #+TOC: headlines [currentsection]
10879 @end example
10880
10881 Beamer specific code can be inserted with the following constructs:
10882
10883 @cindex #+BEAMER
10884 @cindex #+BEGIN_BEAMER
10885 @example
10886 #+BEAMER: \pause
10887
10888 #+BEGIN_BEAMER
10889 All lines in this block will appear only when using this back-end.
10890 #+END_BEAMER
10891
10892 Text @@@@beamer:some code@@@@ within a paragraph.
10893 @end example
10894
10895 In particular, this last example can be used to add overlay specifications to
10896 objects whose type is among @code{bold}, @code{item}, @code{link},
10897 @code{radio-target} and @code{target}, when the value is enclosed within
10898 angular brackets and put at the beginning the object.
10899
10900 @example
10901 A *@@@@beamer:<2->@@@@useful* feature
10902 @end example
10903
10904 @cindex #+ATTR_BEAMER
10905 Eventually, every plain list has support for @code{:environment},
10906 @code{:overlay} and @code{:options} attributes through
10907 @code{ATTR_BEAMER} affiliated keyword. The first one allows the use
10908 of a different environment, the second sets overlay specifications and
10909 the last one inserts optional arguments in current list environment.
10910
10911 @example
10912 #+ATTR_BEAMER: :overlay +-
10913 - item 1
10914 - item 2
10915 @end example
10916
10917 @subheading Editing support
10918
10919 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for faster
10920 editing with:
10921
10922 @example
10923 #+STARTUP: beamer
10924 @end example
10925
10926 @table @kbd
10927 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10928 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a Beamer
10929 environment or the @code{BEAMER_COL} property.
10930 @end table
10931
10932 Also, a template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted
10933 into the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-beamer-insert-options-template}. Among
10934 other things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10935 editing special properties used by Beamer.
10936
10937 @subheading An example
10938
10939 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for Beamer export.
10940
10941 @smallexample
10942 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10943 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10944 #+OPTIONS: H:2
10945 #+LATEX_CLASS: beamer
10946 #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10947 #+BEAMER_THEME: Madrid
10948 #+COLUMNS: %45ITEM %10BEAMER_ENV(Env) %10BEAMER_ACT(Act) %4BEAMER_COL(Col) %8BEAMER_OPT(Opt)
10949
10950 * This is the first structural section
10951
10952 ** Frame 1
10953 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :B_block:BMCOL:
10954 :PROPERTIES:
10955 :BEAMER_COL: 0.48
10956 :BEAMER_ENV: block
10957 :END:
10958 for the first viable Beamer setup in Org
10959 *** Thanks to everyone else :B_block:BMCOL:
10960 :PROPERTIES:
10961 :BEAMER_COL: 0.48
10962 :BEAMER_ACT: <2->
10963 :BEAMER_ENV: block
10964 :END:
10965 for contributing to the discussion
10966 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10967 :PROPERTIES:
10968 :BEAMER_env: note
10969 :END:
10970 ** Frame 2 (where we will not use columns)
10971 *** Request
10972 Please test this stuff!
10973 @end smallexample
10974
10975 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Beamer export, Exporting
10976 @section HTML export
10977 @cindex HTML export
10978
10979 Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10980 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10981 language, but with additional support for tables.
10982
10983 @menu
10984 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10985 * HTML doctypes:: Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors
10986 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10987 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10988 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10989 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10990 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10991 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10992 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10993 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10994 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10995 @end menu
10996
10997 @node HTML Export commands, HTML doctypes, HTML export, HTML export
10998 @subsection HTML export commands
10999
11000 @table @kbd
11001 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h h,org-html-export-to-html}
11002 Export as an HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
11003 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
11004 without warning.
11005 @kbd{C-c C-e h o}
11006 Export as an HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
11007 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h H,org-html-export-as-html}
11008 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
11009 @end table
11010
11011 @c FIXME Exporting sublevels
11012 @c @cindex headline levels, for exporting
11013 @c In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
11014 @c defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
11015 @c itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
11016 @c specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
11017
11018 @c @example
11019 @c @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
11020 @c @end example
11021
11022 @c @noindent
11023 @c creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
11024
11025 @node HTML doctypes, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML Export commands, HTML export
11026 @subsection HTML doctypes
11027 @vindex org-html-doctype
11028 @vindex org-html-doctype-alist
11029
11030 Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors.
11031
11032 Setting the variable @code{org-html-doctype} allows you to export to different
11033 (X)HTML variants. The exported HTML will be adjusted according to the syntax
11034 requirements of that variant. You can either set this variable to a doctype
11035 string directly, in which case the exporter will try to adjust the syntax
11036 automatically, or you can use a ready-made doctype. The ready-made options
11037 are:
11038
11039 @itemize
11040 @item
11041 ``html4-strict''
11042 @item
11043 ``html4-transitional''
11044 @item
11045 ``html4-frameset''
11046 @item
11047 ``xhtml-strict''
11048 @item
11049 ``xhtml-transitional''
11050 @item
11051 ``xhtml-frameset''
11052 @item
11053 ``xhtml-11''
11054 @item
11055 ``html5''
11056 @item
11057 ``xhtml5''
11058 @end itemize
11059
11060 See the variable @code{org-html-doctype-alist} for details. The default is
11061 ``xhtml-strict''.
11062
11063 @subsubheading Fancy HTML5 export
11064 @vindex org-html-html5-fancy
11065 @vindex org-html-html5-elements
11066
11067 HTML5 introduces several new element types. By default, Org will not make
11068 use of these element types, but you can set @code{org-html-html5-fancy} to
11069 @code{t} (or set @code{html5-fancy} item in an @code{OPTIONS} line), to
11070 enable a few new block-level elements. These are created using arbitrary
11071 #+BEGIN and #+END blocks. For instance:
11072
11073 @example
11074 #+BEGIN_ASIDE
11075 Lorem ipsum
11076 #+END_ASIDE
11077 @end example
11078
11079 Will export to:
11080
11081 @example
11082 <aside>
11083 <p>Lorem ipsum</p>
11084 </aside>
11085 @end example
11086
11087 While this:
11088
11089 @example
11090 #+ATTR_HTML: :controls controls :width 350
11091 #+BEGIN_VIDEO
11092 #+HTML: <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4">
11093 #+HTML: <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg">
11094 Your browser does not support the video tag.
11095 #+END_VIDEO
11096 @end example
11097
11098 Becomes:
11099
11100 @example
11101 <video controls="controls" width="350">
11102 <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4">
11103 <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg">
11104 <p>Your browser does not support the video tag.</p>
11105 </video>
11106 @end example
11107
11108 Special blocks that do not correspond to HTML5 elements (see
11109 @code{org-html-html5-elements}) will revert to the usual behavior,
11110 i.e. #+BEGIN_LEDERHOSEN will still export to <div class=''lederhosen''>.
11111
11112 Headlines cannot appear within special blocks. To wrap a headline and its
11113 contents in e.g. <section> or <article> tags, set the @code{HTML_CONTAINER}
11114 property on the headline itself.
11115
11116 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML doctypes, HTML export
11117 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
11118 @vindex org-html-preamble
11119 @vindex org-html-postamble
11120 @vindex org-html-preamble-format
11121 @vindex org-html-postamble-format
11122 @vindex org-html-validation-link
11123 @vindex org-export-creator-string
11124 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
11125
11126 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
11127
11128 The default value for @code{org-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which means
11129 that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string in
11130 @code{org-html-preamble-format}.
11131
11132 Setting @code{org-html-preamble} to a string will override the default format
11133 string. If you set it to a function, it will insert the output of the
11134 function, which must be a string. Setting to @code{nil} will not insert any
11135 preamble.
11136
11137 The default value for @code{org-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which means
11138 that the HTML exporter will look for information about the author, the email,
11139 the creator and the date, and build the postamble from these values. Setting
11140 @code{org-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the postamble from the
11141 relevant format string found in @code{org-html-postamble-format}. Setting it
11142 to @code{nil} will not insert any postamble.
11143
11144 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
11145 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
11146
11147 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
11148 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include raw HTML code, which
11149 should only appear in HTML export, mark it with @samp{@@@@html:} as in
11150 @samp{@@@@html:<b>@@@@bold text@@@@html:</b>@@@@}. For more extensive HTML
11151 that should be copied verbatim to the exported file use either
11152
11153 @cindex #+HTML
11154 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
11155 @example
11156 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
11157 @end example
11158
11159 @noindent or
11160 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
11161
11162 @example
11163 #+BEGIN_HTML
11164 All lines between these markers are exported literally
11165 #+END_HTML
11166 @end example
11167
11168
11169 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
11170 @subsection Links in HTML export
11171
11172 @cindex links, in HTML export
11173 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
11174 @cindex external links, in HTML export
11175 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
11176 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
11177 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
11178 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
11179 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
11180 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
11181 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
11182 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
11183 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
11184
11185 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
11186 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
11187 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
11188 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
11189
11190 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
11191 @example
11192 #+ATTR_HTML: :title The Org mode homepage :style color:red;
11193 [[http://orgmode.org]]
11194 @end example
11195
11196 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
11197 @subsection Tables
11198 @cindex tables, in HTML
11199 @vindex org-html-table-default-attributes
11200
11201 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table attributes defined in
11202 @code{org-html-table-default-attributes}. The default setting makes tables
11203 without cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for
11204 individual tables, place something like the following before the table:
11205
11206 @cindex #+CAPTION
11207 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
11208 @example
11209 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
11210 #+ATTR_HTML: :border 2 :rules all :frame border
11211 @end example
11212
11213 @vindex org-html-table-row-tags
11214 You can also modify the default tags used for each row by setting
11215 @code{org-html-table-row-tags}. See the docstring for an example on
11216 how to use this option.
11217
11218 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
11219 @subsection Images in HTML export
11220
11221 @cindex images, inline in HTML
11222 @cindex inlining images in HTML
11223 @vindex org-html-inline-images
11224 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
11225 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
11226 default@footnote{But see the variable
11227 @code{org-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
11228 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
11229 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
11230 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
11231 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
11232 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
11233 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
11234 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
11235
11236 @example
11237 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
11238 @end example
11239
11240 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
11241 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
11242 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
11243
11244 @cindex #+CAPTION
11245 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
11246 @example
11247 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
11248 #+ATTR_HTML: :alt cat/spider image :title Action! :align right
11249 [[./img/a.jpg]]
11250 @end example
11251
11252 @noindent
11253 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
11254
11255 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
11256 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
11257 @cindex MathJax
11258 @cindex dvipng
11259 @cindex imagemagick
11260
11261 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
11262 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
11263 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
11264 box with Org mode installation because @uref{http://orgmode.org} serves
11265 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
11266 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
11267 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
11268 found on the MathJax website, see
11269 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
11270 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
11271 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-html-mathjax-options} or
11272 insert something like the following into the buffer:
11273
11274 @example
11275 #+HTML_MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
11276 @end example
11277
11278 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
11279 @code{org-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
11280 this line.
11281
11282 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
11283 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
11284 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
11285 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program or @file{imagemagick} suite is
11286 available on your system. You can still get this processing with
11287
11288 @example
11289 #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng
11290 @end example
11291
11292 or:
11293
11294 @example
11295 #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick
11296 @end example
11297
11298 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
11299 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
11300
11301 @cindex text areas, in HTML
11302 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
11303 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
11304 application. It is triggered by @code{:textarea} attribute at an
11305 @code{example} or @code{src} block.
11306
11307 You may also use @code{:height} and @code{:width} attributes to specify the
11308 height and width of the text area, which default to the number of lines in
11309 the example, and 80, respectively. For example
11310
11311 @example
11312 #+ATTR_HTML: :textarea t :width 40
11313 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
11314 (defun org-xor (a b)
11315 "Exclusive or."
11316 (if a (not b) b))
11317 #+END_EXAMPLE
11318 @end example
11319
11320
11321 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
11322 @subsection CSS support
11323 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
11324 @cindex HTML export, CSS
11325
11326 @vindex org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
11327 @vindex org-html-tag-class-prefix
11328 You can modify the CSS style definitions for the exported file. The HTML
11329 exporter assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on
11330 TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
11331 @code{org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and @code{org-html-tag-class-prefix} to
11332 make them unique.} to appropriate parts of the document---your style
11333 specifications may change these, in addition to any of the standard classes
11334 like for headlines, tables, etc.
11335 @example
11336 p.author @r{author information, including email}
11337 p.date @r{publishing date}
11338 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
11339 .title @r{document title}
11340 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
11341 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
11342 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
11343 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
11344 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
11345 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
11346 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
11347 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
11348 .target @r{target for links}
11349 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
11350 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
11351 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
11352 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
11353 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
11354 .figure-number @r{label like "Figure 1:"}
11355 .table-number @r{label like "Table 1:"}
11356 .listing-number @r{label like "Listing 1:"}
11357 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
11358 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
11359 pre.example @r{normal example}
11360 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
11361 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
11362 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
11363 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
11364 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
11365 @end example
11366
11367 @vindex org-html-style-default
11368 @vindex org-html-head-include-default-style
11369 @vindex org-html-head
11370 @vindex org-html-head-extra
11371 @cindex #+HTML_INCLUDE_STYLE
11372 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
11373 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
11374 @code{org-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
11375 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
11376 @code{org-html-head-include-default-style} or set @code{html-style} to
11377 @code{nil} in an @code{OPTIONS} line.}. You may overwrite these settings, or
11378 add to them by using the variables @code{org-html-head} and
11379 @code{org-html-head-extra}. You can override the global values of these
11380 variables for each file by using these keywords:
11381
11382 @cindex #+HTML_HEAD
11383 @cindex #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA
11384 @example
11385 #+HTML_HEAD: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style1.css" />
11386 #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: <link rel="alternate stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style2.css" />
11387 @end example
11388
11389 @noindent
11390 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
11391 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
11392 referring to an external file.
11393
11394 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
11395 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
11396 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
11397 property.
11398
11399 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
11400 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
11401
11402 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
11403 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
11404
11405 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
11406 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
11407 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
11408 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
11409 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
11410 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
11411 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
11412 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
11413 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
11414 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
11415 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might not want
11416 to be dependent on @url{http://orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
11417 copy on your own web server.
11418
11419 All it then takes to use this program is adding a single line to the Org
11420 file:
11421
11422 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
11423 @example
11424 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
11425 @end example
11426
11427 @noindent
11428 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
11429 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
11430 viewing options:
11431
11432 @example
11433 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
11434 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
11435 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
11436 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
11437 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
11438 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
11439 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
11440 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
11441 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
11442 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
11443 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
11444 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
11445 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
11446 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
11447 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
11448 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
11449 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
11450 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
11451 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
11452 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
11453 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
11454 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
11455 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
11456 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
11457 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
11458 @end example
11459 @noindent
11460 @vindex org-html-infojs-options
11461 @vindex org-html-use-infojs
11462 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
11463 @code{org-html-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
11464 pages, configure the variable @code{org-html-use-infojs}.
11465
11466 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Markdown export, HTML export, Exporting
11467 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
11468 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
11469 @cindex PDF export
11470
11471 @LaTeX{} export can produce an arbitrarily complex LaTeX document of any
11472 standard or custom document class. With further processing@footnote{The
11473 default @LaTeX{} output is designed for processing with @code{pdftex} or
11474 @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not compatible with @code{xetex} and
11475 possibly @code{luatex}. The @LaTeX{} exporter can be configured to support
11476 alternative TeX engines, see the options
11477 @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} and @code{org-latex-packages-alist}.},
11478 which the @LaTeX{} exporter is able to control, this back-end is able to
11479 produce PDF output. Because the @LaTeX{} exporter can be configured to use
11480 the @code{hyperref} package, the default setup produces fully-linked PDF
11481 output.
11482
11483 As in @LaTeX{}, blank lines are meaningful for this back-end: a paragraph
11484 will not be started if two contiguous syntactical elements are not separated
11485 by an empty line.
11486
11487 This back-end also offers enhanced support for footnotes. Thus, it handles
11488 nested footnotes, footnotes in tables and footnotes in a list item's
11489 description.
11490
11491 @menu
11492 * @LaTeX{} export commands:: How to export to LaTeX and PDF
11493 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
11494 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
11495 * @LaTeX{} specific attributes:: Controlling @LaTeX{} output
11496 @end menu
11497
11498 @node @LaTeX{} export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
11499 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
11500
11501 @table @kbd
11502 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l l,org-latex-export-to-latex}
11503 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{}
11504 file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will be overwritten without
11505 warning.
11506 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l L,org-latex-export-as-latex}
11507 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
11508 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l p,org-latex-export-to-pdf}
11509 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
11510 @item C-c C-e l o
11511 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
11512 @end table
11513
11514 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
11515 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
11516 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
11517 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
11518 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
11519 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
11520 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
11521
11522 By default, the first three outline levels become headlines, defining a
11523 general document structure. Additional levels are exported as @code{itemize}
11524 or @code{enumerate} lists. The transition can also occur at a different
11525 level (@pxref{Export settings}).
11526
11527 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
11528
11529 @vindex org-latex-default-class
11530 @vindex org-latex-classes
11531 @vindex org-latex-default-packages-alist
11532 @vindex org-latex-packages-alist
11533 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
11534 @code{org-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
11535 @code{#+LATEX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with
11536 a @code{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS} property that applies when exporting a region
11537 containing only this (sub)tree. The class must be listed in
11538 @code{org-latex-classes}. This variable defines a header template for each
11539 class@footnote{Into which the values of
11540 @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} and @code{org-latex-packages-alist}
11541 are spliced.}, and allows you to define the sectioning structure for each
11542 class. You can also define your own classes there.
11543
11544 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
11545 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
11546 @cindex property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS
11547 @cindex property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
11548 The @code{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS} keyword or @code{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
11549 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. These
11550 options have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within square brackets.
11551
11552 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
11553 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA
11554 You can also use the @code{LATEX_HEADER} and
11555 @code{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA}@footnote{Unlike @code{LATEX_HEADER}, contents
11556 from @code{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA} keywords will not be loaded when previewing
11557 @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments}).} keywords in order
11558 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of @code{org-latex-classes} for
11559 more information.
11560
11561 An example is shown below.
11562
11563 @example
11564 #+LATEX_CLASS: article
11565 #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
11566 #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
11567
11568 * Headline 1
11569 some text
11570 @end example
11571
11572 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} specific attributes, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
11573 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
11574
11575 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
11576 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. Furthermore, you can add special code that
11577 should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with the following constructs:
11578
11579 @cindex #+LATEX
11580 @cindex #+BEGIN_LATEX
11581 @example
11582 Code within @@@@latex:some code@@@@ a paragraph.
11583
11584 #+LATEX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
11585
11586 #+BEGIN_LATEX
11587 All lines between these markers are exported literally
11588 #+END_LATEX
11589 @end example
11590
11591 @node @LaTeX{} specific attributes, , Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
11592 @subsection @LaTeX{} specific attributes
11593 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX
11594
11595 @LaTeX{} understands attributes specified in an @code{ATTR_LATEX} line. They
11596 affect tables, images, plain lists, special blocks and source blocks.
11597
11598 @subsubheading Tables in @LaTeX{} export
11599 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
11600
11601 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
11602 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use attributes to control table
11603 layout and contents. Valid @LaTeX{} attributes include:
11604
11605 @table @code
11606 @item :mode
11607 @vindex org-latex-default-table-mode
11608 Nature of table's contents. It can be set to @code{table}, @code{math},
11609 @code{inline-math} or @code{verbatim}. In particular, when in @code{math} or
11610 @code{inline-math} mode, every cell is exported as-is, horizontal rules are
11611 ignored and the table will be wrapped in a math environment. Also,
11612 contiguous tables sharing the same math mode will be wrapped within the same
11613 environment. Default mode is determined in
11614 @code{org-latex-default-table-mode}.
11615 @item :environment
11616 @vindex org-latex-default-table-environment
11617 Environment used for the table. It can be set to any @LaTeX{} table
11618 environment, like @code{tabularx}@footnote{Requires adding the
11619 @code{tabularx} package to @code{org-latex-packages-alist}.},
11620 @code{longtable}, @code{array}, @code{tabu}@footnote{Requires adding the
11621 @code{tabu} package to @code{org-latex-packages-alist}.},
11622 @code{bmatrix}@enddots{} It defaults to
11623 @code{org-latex-default-table-environment} value.
11624 @item :caption
11625 @code{#+CAPTION} keyword is the simplest way to set a caption for a table
11626 (@pxref{Images and tables}). If you need more advanced commands for that
11627 task, you can use @code{:caption} attribute instead. Its value should be raw
11628 @LaTeX{} code. It has precedence over @code{#+CAPTION}.
11629 @item :float
11630 @itemx :placement
11631 Float environment for the table. Possible values are @code{sidewaystable},
11632 @code{multicolumn}, @code{t} and @code{nil}. When unspecified, a table with
11633 a caption will have a @code{table} environment. Moreover, @code{:placement}
11634 attribute can specify the positioning of the float.
11635 @item :align
11636 @itemx :font
11637 @itemx :width
11638 Set, respectively, the alignment string of the table, its font size and its
11639 width. They only apply on regular tables.
11640 @item :spread
11641 Boolean specific to the @code{tabu} and @code{longtabu} environments, and
11642 only takes effect when used in conjunction with the @code{:width} attribute.
11643 When @code{:spread} is non-@code{nil}, the table will be spread or shrunk by the
11644 value of @code{:width}.
11645 @item :booktabs
11646 @itemx :center
11647 @itemx :rmlines
11648 @vindex org-latex-tables-booktabs
11649 @vindex org-latex-tables-centered
11650 They toggle, respectively, @code{booktabs} usage (assuming the package is
11651 properly loaded), table centering and removal of every horizontal rule but
11652 the first one (in a "table.el" table only). In particular,
11653 @code{org-latex-tables-booktabs} (respectively @code{org-latex-tables-centered})
11654 activates the first (respectively second) attribute globally.
11655 @item :math-prefix
11656 @itemx :math-suffix
11657 @itemx :math-arguments
11658 A string that will be inserted, respectively, before the table within the
11659 math environment, after the table within the math environment, and between
11660 the macro name and the contents of the table. The @code{:math-arguments}
11661 attribute is used for matrix macros that require more than one argument
11662 (e.g., @code{qbordermatrix}).
11663 @end table
11664
11665 Thus, attributes can be used in a wide array of situations, like writing
11666 a table that will span over multiple pages, or a matrix product:
11667
11668 @example
11669 #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment longtable :align l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
11670 | ..... | ..... |
11671 | ..... | ..... |
11672
11673 #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix :math-suffix \times
11674 | a | b |
11675 | c | d |
11676 #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix
11677 | 1 | 2 |
11678 | 3 | 4 |
11679 @end example
11680
11681 In the example below, @LaTeX{} command
11682 @code{\bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}} will set the caption.
11683
11684 @example
11685 #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}
11686 | ..... | ..... |
11687 | ..... | ..... |
11688 @end example
11689
11690
11691 @subsubheading Images in @LaTeX{} export
11692 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
11693 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
11694
11695 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
11696 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
11697 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
11698 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image@footnote{In the case of
11699 TikZ (@url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/pgf/}) images, it will become an
11700 @code{\input} macro wrapped within a @code{tikzpicture} environment.}.
11701
11702 You can specify specify image width or height with, respectively,
11703 @code{:width} and @code{:height} attributes. It is also possible to add any
11704 other option with the @code{:options} attribute, as shown in the following
11705 example:
11706
11707 @example
11708 #+ATTR_LATEX: :width 5cm :options angle=90
11709 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
11710 @end example
11711
11712 If you need a specific command for the caption, use @code{:caption}
11713 attribute. It will override standard @code{#+CAPTION} value, if any.
11714
11715 @example
11716 #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}
11717 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
11718 @end example
11719
11720 If you have specified a caption as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the
11721 picture will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become
11722 a floating element. You can also ask Org to export an image as a float
11723 without specifying caption by setting the @code{:float} attribute. You may
11724 also set it to:
11725 @itemize @minus
11726 @item
11727 @code{t}: if you want to use the standard @samp{figure} environment. It is
11728 used by default if you provide a caption to the image.
11729 @item
11730 @code{multicolumn}: if you wish to include an image which spans multiple
11731 columns in a page. This will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*}
11732 environment.
11733 @item
11734 @code{wrap}: if you would like to let text flow around the image. It will
11735 make the figure occupy the left half of the page.
11736 @item
11737 @code{nil}: if you need to avoid any floating environment, even when
11738 a caption is provided.
11739 @end itemize
11740 @noindent
11741 To modify the placement option of any floating environment, set the
11742 @code{placement} attribute.
11743
11744 @example
11745 #+ATTR_LATEX: :float wrap :width 0.38\textwidth :placement @{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
11746 [[./img/hst.png]]
11747 @end example
11748
11749 If the @code{:comment-include} attribute is set to a non-@code{nil} value,
11750 the @LaTeX{} @code{\includegraphics} macro will be commented out.
11751
11752 @subsubheading Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export
11753 @cindex plain lists, in @LaTeX{} export
11754
11755 Plain lists accept two optional attributes: @code{:environment} and
11756 @code{:options}. The first one allows the use of a non-standard
11757 environment (e.g., @samp{inparaenum}). The second one specifies
11758 optional arguments for that environment (square brackets may be
11759 omitted).
11760
11761 @example
11762 #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment compactitem :options $\circ$
11763 - you need ``paralist'' package to reproduce this example.
11764 @end example
11765
11766 @subsubheading Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export
11767 @cindex source blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
11768
11769 In addition to syntax defined in @ref{Literal examples}, names and captions
11770 (@pxref{Images and tables}), source blocks also accept a @code{:float}
11771 attribute. You may set it to:
11772 @itemize @minus
11773 @item
11774 @code{t}: if you want to make the source block a float. It is the default
11775 value when a caption is provided.
11776 @item
11777 @code{multicolumn}: if you wish to include a source block which spans multiple
11778 columns in a page.
11779 @item
11780 @code{nil}: if you need to avoid any floating environment, even when a caption
11781 is provided. It is useful for source code that may not fit in a single page.
11782 @end itemize
11783
11784 @example
11785 #+ATTR_LATEX: :float nil
11786 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11787 Code that may not fit in a single page.
11788 #+END_SRC
11789 @end example
11790
11791 @subsubheading Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export
11792 @cindex special blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
11793
11794 In @LaTeX{} back-end, special blocks become environments of the same name.
11795 Value of @code{:options} attribute will be appended as-is to that
11796 environment's opening string. For example:
11797
11798 @example
11799 #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [Proof of important theorem]
11800 #+BEGIN_PROOF
11801 ...
11802 Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes.
11803 #+END_PROOF
11804 @end example
11805
11806 @noindent
11807 becomes
11808
11809 @example
11810 \begin@{proof@}[Proof of important theorem]
11811 ...
11812 Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes.
11813 \end@{proof@}
11814 @end example
11815
11816 If you need to insert a specific caption command, use @code{:caption}
11817 attribute. It will override standard @code{#+CAPTION} value, if any. For
11818 example:
11819
11820 @example
11821 #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \MyCaption@{HeadingA@}
11822 #+BEGIN_PROOF
11823 ...
11824 #+END_PROOF
11825 @end example
11826
11827 @subsubheading Horizontal rules
11828 @cindex horizontal rules, in @LaTeX{} export
11829
11830 Width and thickness of a given horizontal rule can be controlled with,
11831 respectively, @code{:width} and @code{:thickness} attributes:
11832
11833 @example
11834 #+ATTR_LATEX: :width .6\textwidth :thickness 0.8pt
11835 -----
11836 @end example
11837
11838 @node Markdown export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
11839 @section Markdown export
11840 @cindex Markdown export
11841
11842 @code{md} export back-end generates Markdown syntax@footnote{Vanilla flavor,
11843 as defined at @url{http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/}.} for an Org
11844 mode buffer.
11845
11846 It is built over HTML back-end: any construct not supported by Markdown
11847 syntax (e.g., tables) will be controlled and translated by @code{html}
11848 back-end (@pxref{HTML export}).
11849
11850 @subheading Markdown export commands
11851
11852 @table @kbd
11853 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m m,org-md-export-to-markdown}
11854 Export as a text file written in Markdown syntax. For an Org file,
11855 @file{myfile.org}, the resulting file will be @file{myfile.md}. The file
11856 will be overwritten without warning.
11857 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m M,org-md-export-as-markdown}
11858 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
11859 @item C-c C-e m o
11860 Export as a text file with Markdown syntax, then open it.
11861 @end table
11862
11863 @subheading Header and sectioning structure
11864
11865 @vindex org-md-headline-style
11866 Markdown export can generate both @code{atx} and @code{setext} types for
11867 headlines, according to @code{org-md-headline-style}. The former introduces
11868 a hard limit of two levels, whereas the latter pushes it to six. Headlines
11869 below that limit are exported as lists. You can also set a soft limit before
11870 that one (@pxref{Export settings}).
11871
11872 @c begin opendocument
11873
11874 @node OpenDocument Text export, iCalendar export, Markdown export, Exporting
11875 @section OpenDocument Text export
11876 @cindex ODT
11877 @cindex OpenDocument
11878 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11879 @cindex LibreOffice
11880
11881 Org mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11882 (ODT) format. Documents created by this exporter use the
11883 @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11884 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11885 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11886 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11887
11888 @menu
11889 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11890 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11891 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11892 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11893 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11894 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11895 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11896 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11897 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11898 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11899 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11900 @end menu
11901
11902 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11903 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11904 @cindex zip
11905 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11906 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11907
11908 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11909 @subsection ODT export commands
11910
11911 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11912 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11913
11914 @cindex region, active
11915 @cindex active region
11916 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11917 @table @kbd
11918 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o o,org-odt-export-to-odt}
11919 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11920
11921 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11922
11923 @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format
11924 If @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically convert
11925 the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11926 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11927
11928 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11929 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11930 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11931 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11932 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11933 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11934 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11935 export.
11936
11937 @kbd{C-c C-e o O}
11938 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11939
11940 @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format
11941 If @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the converted
11942 file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically exporting to
11943 other formats}.
11944 @end table
11945
11946 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11947 @subsection Extending ODT export
11948
11949 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11950 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11951 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11952 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11953
11954 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11955 @cindex LibreOffice
11956 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11957 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11958 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11959 @code{org-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11960 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11961 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11962 document converter}.
11963
11964 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11965 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11966
11967 @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format
11968 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11969 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11970 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11971 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11972 @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11973 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11974 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11975
11976 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11977 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11978
11979 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11980 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11981 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11982 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11983 the following command.
11984
11985 @vindex org-odt-convert
11986 @table @kbd
11987
11988 @item M-x org-odt-convert RET
11989 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11990 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11991 @end table
11992
11993 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11994 @subsection Applying custom styles
11995 @cindex styles, custom
11996 @cindex template, custom
11997
11998 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11999 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
12000 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
12001 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
12002 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
12003 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
12004 users alike, and is described here.
12005
12006 @subsubsection Applying custom styles: the easy way
12007
12008 @enumerate
12009 @item
12010 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
12011 to ODT format.
12012
12013 @example
12014 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
12015 @end example
12016
12017 @item
12018 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
12019 to locate the target styles---these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix---and
12020 modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
12021 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
12022
12023 @item
12024 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
12025 @vindex org-odt-styles-file
12026 Customize the variable @code{org-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
12027 newly created file. For additional configuration options
12028 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
12029
12030 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
12031 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
12032
12033 @example
12034 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
12035 @end example
12036
12037 or
12038
12039 @example
12040 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
12041 @end example
12042
12043 @end enumerate
12044
12045 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
12046
12047 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
12048 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
12049 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
12050 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
12051 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
12052 the factory settings.
12053
12054 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
12055 @subsection Links in ODT export
12056 @cindex links, in ODT export
12057
12058 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
12059 Internet-style links for all other links.
12060
12061 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
12062 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
12063
12064 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
12065 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
12066 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
12067
12068 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
12069 @subsection Tables in ODT export
12070 @cindex tables, in ODT export
12071
12072 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
12073 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables---tables
12074 that have column or row spans---is not supported. Such tables are
12075 stripped from the exported document.
12076
12077 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
12078 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
12079 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
12080 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
12081 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
12082 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
12083
12084 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
12085 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
12086 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
12087
12088 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
12089 mentioned above.
12090
12091 @example
12092 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
12093 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
12094 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
12095 | / | < | | | < |
12096 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
12097 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
12098 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
12099 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
12100 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
12101 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
12102 @end example
12103
12104 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
12105 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
12106 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
12107 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
12108 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
12109
12110 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
12111 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
12112 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
12113
12114 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
12115 @subsection Images in ODT export
12116 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
12117 @cindex embedding images in ODT
12118
12119 @subsubheading Embedding images
12120 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
12121 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
12122 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
12123
12124 @example
12125 [[file:img.png]]
12126 @end example
12127
12128 @example
12129 [[./img.png]]
12130 @end example
12131
12132 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
12133 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
12134 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
12135 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
12136 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
12137
12138 @example
12139 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
12140 @end example
12141
12142 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
12143
12144 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
12145 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
12146 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
12147
12148 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
12149 @vindex org-odt-pixels-per-inch
12150 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
12151 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
12152 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
12153 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
12154 APIs@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
12155 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
12156 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
12157 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.}. The pixel dimensions are subsequently
12158 converted in to units of centimeters using
12159 @code{org-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
12160 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
12161 achieve the best results.
12162
12163 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
12164
12165 @table @asis
12166 @item Explicitly size the image
12167 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
12168
12169 @example
12170 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
12171 [[./img.png]]
12172 @end example
12173
12174 @item Scale the image
12175 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
12176
12177 @example
12178 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
12179 [[./img.png]]
12180 @end example
12181
12182 @item Scale the image to a specific width
12183 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
12184 height:width ratio, do the following:
12185
12186 @example
12187 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
12188 [[./img.png]]
12189 @end example
12190
12191 @item Scale the image to a specific height
12192 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
12193 height:width ratio, do the following
12194
12195 @example
12196 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
12197 [[./img.png]]
12198 @end example
12199 @end table
12200
12201 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
12202
12203 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
12204 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
12205 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
12206 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property:
12207 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
12208
12209 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
12210 @example
12211 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
12212 [[./img.png]]
12213 @end example
12214
12215 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
12216 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
12217
12218 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
12219
12220 @menu
12221 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
12222 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
12223 @end menu
12224
12225 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
12226 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
12227
12228 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
12229 document in one of the following ways:
12230
12231 @cindex MathML
12232 @enumerate
12233 @item MathML
12234
12235 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
12236
12237 @example
12238 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t
12239 @end example
12240
12241 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
12242 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
12243 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
12244 the exported document.
12245
12246 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
12247 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
12248
12249 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
12250 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
12251 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
12252
12253 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
12254 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
12255 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
12256
12257 @lisp
12258 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
12259 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
12260 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
12261 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
12262 @end lisp
12263
12264 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
12265 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
12266
12267 @table @kbd
12268 @item M-x org-odt-export-as-odf RET
12269 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
12270
12271 @item M-x org-odt-export-as-odf-and-open RET
12272 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
12273 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
12274 @end table
12275
12276 @cindex dvipng
12277 @cindex imagemagick
12278 @item PNG images
12279
12280 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
12281
12282 @example
12283 #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng
12284 @end example
12285
12286 or:
12287
12288 @example
12289 #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick
12290 @end example
12291
12292 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
12293 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
12294 that the @file{dvipng} program or @file{imagemagick} suite be available on
12295 your system.
12296 @end enumerate
12297
12298 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
12299 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
12300
12301 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
12302 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
12303 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
12304 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
12305
12306 @example
12307 [[./equation.mml]]
12308 @end example
12309
12310 or
12311
12312 @example
12313 [[./equation.odf]]
12314 @end example
12315
12316 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
12317 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
12318
12319 You can label and caption various category of objects---an inline image, a
12320 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula---using @code{#+LABEL} and
12321 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
12322 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
12323 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
12324 appearance in the Org file.
12325
12326 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
12327 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
12328 file.
12329
12330 @example
12331 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
12332 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
12333 [[./img/a.png]]
12334 @end example
12335
12336 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
12337
12338 @example
12339 Figure 2: Bell curve
12340 @end example
12341
12342 @vindex org-odt-category-map-alist
12343 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
12344 option @code{org-odt-category-map-alist}. For example, to tag all embedded
12345 images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
12346 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting:
12347
12348 @lisp
12349 (setq org-odt-category-map-alist
12350 (("__Figure__" "Illustration" "value" "Figure" org-odt--enumerable-image-p)))
12351 @end lisp
12352
12353 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
12354 document.
12355
12356 @example
12357 Illustration 2: Bell curve
12358 @end example
12359
12360 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
12361 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
12362
12363 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
12364 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
12365 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
12366 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
12367 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
12368 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
12369 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
12370
12371 @vindex org-odt-fontify-srcblocks
12372 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do
12373 so by customizing the option
12374 @code{org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
12375
12376 @vindex org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
12377 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
12378 option @code{org-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
12379
12380 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
12381 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
12382
12383 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
12384 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
12385 that would be of interest to power users.
12386
12387 @menu
12388 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
12389 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
12390 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
12391 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
12392 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
12393 @end menu
12394
12395 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
12396 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
12397 @cindex convert
12398 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
12399 @cindex converter
12400
12401 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
12402 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
12403 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
12404 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
12405
12406 @enumerate
12407 @item Register the converter
12408
12409 @vindex org-odt-convert-processes
12410 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by
12411 customizing the option @code{org-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how
12412 the converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
12413
12414 @item Configure its capabilities
12415
12416 @vindex org-odt-convert-capabilities
12417 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities} Specify the set of formats the
12418 converter can handle by customizing the variable
12419 @code{org-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value for this
12420 variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by the
12421 default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
12422 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
12423 just the OpenDocument Text format.
12424
12425 @item Choose the converter
12426
12427 @vindex org-odt-convert-process
12428 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
12429 option @code{org-odt-convert-process}.
12430 @end enumerate
12431
12432 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
12433 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
12434 @cindex styles, custom
12435 @cindex template, custom
12436
12437 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
12438 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
12439 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
12440 the exporter.
12441
12442 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
12443 @subsubheading Factory styles
12444
12445 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
12446 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
12447 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
12448
12449 @itemize
12450 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
12451 @item
12452 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
12453
12454 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
12455 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
12456 @enumerate
12457
12458 @item
12459 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
12460
12461 @item
12462 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
12463 blocks.
12464 @end enumerate
12465
12466 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
12467 @item
12468 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
12469
12470 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
12471 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
12472 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
12473
12474 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
12475 file serves the following purposes:
12476 @enumerate
12477
12478 @item
12479 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
12480 the exporter.
12481
12482 @item
12483 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
12484 elements that control how various entities---tables, images, equations,
12485 etc.---are numbered.
12486 @end enumerate
12487 @end itemize
12488
12489 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
12490 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
12491 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
12492 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
12493 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
12494 exporter.
12495
12496 @itemize
12497 @anchor{x-org-odt-styles-file}
12498 @item
12499 @code{org-odt-styles-file}
12500
12501 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
12502 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
12503
12504 @enumerate
12505 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
12506
12507 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
12508
12509 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
12510
12511 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
12512 Template file
12513
12514 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
12515
12516 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
12517 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
12518 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
12519
12520 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
12521 like header and footer images.
12522
12523 @item @code{nil}
12524
12525 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
12526 @end enumerate
12527
12528 @anchor{x-org-odt-content-template-file}
12529 @item
12530 @code{org-odt-content-template-file}
12531
12532 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
12533 in the final output.
12534 @end itemize
12535
12536 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
12537 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
12538
12539 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
12540 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
12541 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
12542
12543 @enumerate
12544 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
12545
12546 You can inline OpenDocument syntax by enclosing it within
12547 @samp{@@@@odt:...@@@@} markup. For example, to highlight a region of text do
12548 the following:
12549
12550 @example
12551 @@@@odt:<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a highlighted
12552 text</text:span>@@@@. But this is a regular text.
12553 @end example
12554
12555 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
12556 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
12557 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
12558
12559 @example
12560 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
12561 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
12562 </style:style>
12563 @end example
12564
12565 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
12566
12567 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
12568 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
12569
12570 @example
12571 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
12572 @end example
12573
12574 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
12575 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
12576 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
12577
12578 @example
12579 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
12580 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
12581 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
12582 </style:style>
12583 @end example
12584
12585 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
12586
12587 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
12588 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
12589
12590 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
12591 following:
12592
12593 @example
12594 #+BEGIN_ODT
12595 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
12596 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
12597 </text:p>
12598 #+END_ODT
12599 @end example
12600
12601 @end enumerate
12602
12603 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
12604 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
12605 @cindex tables, in ODT export
12606
12607 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
12608 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
12609 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
12610 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
12611
12612 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
12613 OpenDocument-v1.2
12614 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
12615 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
12616
12617 @subsubheading Custom table styles: an illustration
12618
12619 @vindex org-odt-table-styles
12620 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and
12621 export the table that follows:
12622
12623 @lisp
12624 (setq org-odt-table-styles
12625 (append org-odt-table-styles
12626 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
12627 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
12628 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
12629 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
12630 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
12631 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
12632 @end lisp
12633
12634 @example
12635 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
12636 | Name | Phone | Age |
12637 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
12638 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
12639 @end example
12640
12641 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
12642 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
12643 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
12644 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for
12645 you. These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom
12646 Table Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
12647 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
12648 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
12649
12650 @subsubheading Custom table styles: the nitty-gritty
12651 To use this feature proceed as follows:
12652
12653 @enumerate
12654 @item
12655 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
12656 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
12657
12658 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
12659 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
12660
12661 @itemize @minus
12662 @item Body
12663 @item First column
12664 @item Last column
12665 @item First row
12666 @item Last row
12667 @item Even row
12668 @item Odd row
12669 @item Even column
12670 @item Odd Column
12671 @end itemize
12672
12673 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
12674 template using a well-defined convention.
12675
12676 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
12677 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
12678 the following table.
12679
12680 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
12681 @headitem Table cell type
12682 @tab @code{table-cell} style
12683 @tab @code{paragraph} style
12684 @item
12685 @tab
12686 @tab
12687 @item Body
12688 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
12689 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
12690 @item First column
12691 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
12692 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
12693 @item Last column
12694 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
12695 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
12696 @item First row
12697 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
12698 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
12699 @item Last row
12700 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
12701 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
12702 @item Even row
12703 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
12704 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
12705 @item Odd row
12706 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
12707 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
12708 @item Even column
12709 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
12710 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
12711 @item Odd column
12712 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
12713 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
12714 @end multitable
12715
12716 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
12717 styles in the
12718 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
12719 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
12720 styles}).
12721
12722 @item
12723 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
12724 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
12725 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
12726 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
12727 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
12728 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
12729
12730 @vindex org-odt-table-styles
12731 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
12732 @code{org-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
12733
12734 @itemize @minus
12735 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
12736 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
12737 @end itemize
12738
12739 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
12740 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
12741 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
12742 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
12743
12744 @lisp
12745 (setq org-odt-table-styles
12746 (append org-odt-table-styles
12747 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
12748 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
12749 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
12750 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
12751 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
12752 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
12753 @end lisp
12754
12755 @item
12756 Associate a table with the table style
12757
12758 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
12759 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
12760
12761 @example
12762 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
12763 | Name | Phone | Age |
12764 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
12765 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
12766 @end example
12767 @end enumerate
12768
12769 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
12770 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
12771
12772 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
12773 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
12774 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
12775 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
12776 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
12777
12778 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
12779 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
12780 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
12781 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
12782
12783 @vindex org-odt-schema-dir
12784 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
12785 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
12786 @code{org-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The ODT exporter
12787 will take care of updating the @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
12788
12789 @c end opendocument
12790
12791 @node iCalendar export, Other built-in back-ends, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
12792 @section iCalendar export
12793 @cindex iCalendar export
12794
12795 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12796 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12797 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12798 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12799 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12800 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12801 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12802 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12803 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12804 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12805 included in the export, configure the variable
12806 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12807 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12808 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12809 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12810 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12811 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12812 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12813 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12814 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12815 time.
12816
12817 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12818 @cindex property, ID
12819 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12820 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12821 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12822 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12823 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12824 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12825 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12826 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12827 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12828
12829 @table @kbd
12830 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c f,org-icalendar-export-to-ics}
12831 Create iCalendar entries for the current buffer and store them in the same
12832 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12833 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c a, org-icalendar-export-agenda-files}
12834 @vindex org-agenda-files
12835 Like @kbd{C-c C-e c f}, but do this for all files in
12836 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12837 file will be written.
12838 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c c,org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12839 @vindex org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file
12840 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12841 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12842 @code{org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file}.
12843 @end table
12844
12845 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12846 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12847 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12848 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12849 @cindex property, LOCATION
12850 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12851 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12852 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12853 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12854 and the description from the body (limited to
12855 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12856
12857 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12858 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12859
12860 @node Other built-in back-ends, Export in foreign buffers, iCalendar export, Exporting
12861 @section Other built-in back-ends
12862 @cindex export back-ends, built-in
12863 @vindex org-export-backends
12864
12865 On top of the aforementioned back-ends, Org comes with other built-in ones:
12866
12867 @itemize
12868 @item @file{ox-man.el}: export to a man page.
12869 @item @file{ox-texinfo.el}: export to @code{Texinfo} format.
12870 @item @file{ox-org.el}: export to an Org document.
12871 @end itemize
12872
12873 To activate these export back-end, customize @code{org-export-backends} or
12874 load them directly with e.g., @code{(require 'ox-texinfo)}. This will add
12875 new keys in the export dispatcher (@pxref{The Export Dispatcher}).
12876
12877 See the comment section of these files for more information on how to use
12878 them.
12879
12880 @node Export in foreign buffers, Advanced configuration, Other built-in back-ends, Exporting
12881 @section Export in foreign buffers
12882
12883 Most built-in back-ends come with a command to convert the selected region
12884 into a selected format and replace this region by the exported output. Here
12885 is a list of such conversion commands:
12886
12887 @table @code
12888 @item org-html-convert-region-to-html
12889 Convert the selected region into HTML.
12890 @item org-latex-convert-region-to-latex
12891 Convert the selected region into @LaTeX{}.
12892 @item org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo
12893 Convert the selected region into @code{Texinfo}.
12894 @item org-md-convert-region-to-md
12895 Convert the selected region into @code{MarkDown}.
12896 @end table
12897
12898 This is particularly useful for converting tables and lists in foreign
12899 buffers. E.g., in an HTML buffer, you can turn on @code{orgstruct-mode}, then
12900 use Org commands for editing a list, and finally select and convert the list
12901 with @code{M-x org-html-convert-region-to-html RET}.
12902
12903 @node Advanced configuration, , Export in foreign buffers, Exporting
12904 @section Advanced configuration
12905
12906 @subheading Hooks
12907
12908 @vindex org-export-before-processing-hook
12909 @vindex org-export-before-parsing-hook
12910 Two hooks are run during the first steps of the export process. The first
12911 one, @code{org-export-before-processing-hook} is called before expanding
12912 macros, Babel code and include keywords in the buffer. The second one,
12913 @code{org-export-before-parsing-hook}, as its name suggests, happens just
12914 before parsing the buffer. Their main use is for heavy duties, that is
12915 duties involving structural modifications of the document. For example, one
12916 may want to remove every headline in the buffer during export. The following
12917 code can achieve this:
12918
12919 @lisp
12920 @group
12921 (defun my-headline-removal (backend)
12922 "Remove all headlines in the current buffer.
12923 BACKEND is the export back-end being used, as a symbol."
12924 (org-map-entries
12925 (lambda () (delete-region (point) (progn (forward-line) (point))))))
12926
12927 (add-hook 'org-export-before-parsing-hook 'my-headline-removal)
12928 @end group
12929 @end lisp
12930
12931 Note that functions used in these hooks require a mandatory argument,
12932 a symbol representing the back-end used.
12933
12934 @subheading Filters
12935
12936 @cindex Filters, exporting
12937 Filters are lists of functions applied on a specific part of the output from
12938 a given back-end. More explicitly, each time a back-end transforms an Org
12939 object or element into another language, all functions within a given filter
12940 type are called in turn on the string produced. The string returned by the
12941 last function will be the one used in the final output.
12942
12943 There are filters sets for each type of element or object, for plain text,
12944 for the parse tree, for the export options and for the final output. They
12945 are all named after the same scheme: @code{org-export-filter-TYPE-functions},
12946 where @code{TYPE} is the type targeted by the filter. Valid types are:
12947
12948 @multitable @columnfractions .33 .33 .33
12949 @item bold
12950 @tab babel-call
12951 @tab center-block
12952 @item clock
12953 @tab code
12954 @tab comment
12955 @item comment-block
12956 @tab diary-sexp
12957 @tab drawer
12958 @item dynamic-block
12959 @tab entity
12960 @tab example-block
12961 @item export-block
12962 @tab export-snippet
12963 @tab final-output
12964 @item fixed-width
12965 @tab footnote-definition
12966 @tab footnote-reference
12967 @item headline
12968 @tab horizontal-rule
12969 @tab inline-babel-call
12970 @item inline-src-block
12971 @tab inlinetask
12972 @tab italic
12973 @item item
12974 @tab keyword
12975 @tab latex-environment
12976 @item latex-fragment
12977 @tab line-break
12978 @tab link
12979 @item node-property
12980 @tab options
12981 @tab paragraph
12982 @item parse-tree
12983 @tab plain-list
12984 @tab plain-text
12985 @item planning
12986 @tab property-drawer
12987 @tab quote-block
12988 @item quote-section
12989 @tab radio-target
12990 @tab section
12991 @item special-block
12992 @tab src-block
12993 @tab statistics-cookie
12994 @item strike-through
12995 @tab subscript
12996 @tab superscript
12997 @item table
12998 @tab table-cell
12999 @tab table-row
13000 @item target
13001 @tab timestamp
13002 @tab underline
13003 @item verbatim
13004 @tab verse-block
13005 @tab
13006 @end multitable
13007
13008 For example, the following snippet allows me to use non-breaking spaces in
13009 the Org buffer and get them translated into @LaTeX{} without using the
13010 @code{\nbsp} macro (where @code{_} stands for the non-breaking space):
13011
13012 @lisp
13013 @group
13014 (defun my-latex-filter-nobreaks (text backend info)
13015 "Ensure \" \" are properly handled in LaTeX export."
13016 (when (org-export-derived-backend-p backend 'latex)
13017 (replace-regexp-in-string " " "~" text)))
13018
13019 (add-to-list 'org-export-filter-plain-text-functions
13020 'my-latex-filter-nobreaks)
13021 @end group
13022 @end lisp
13023
13024 Three arguments must be provided to a filter: the code being changed, the
13025 back-end used, and some information about the export process. You can safely
13026 ignore the third argument for most purposes. Note the use of
13027 @code{org-export-derived-backend-p}, which ensures that the filter will only
13028 be applied when using @code{latex} back-end or any other back-end derived
13029 from it (e.g., @code{beamer}).
13030
13031 @subheading Extending an existing back-end
13032
13033 This is obviously the most powerful customization, since the changes happen
13034 at the parser level. Indeed, some export back-ends are built as extensions
13035 of other ones (e.g. Markdown back-end an extension of HTML back-end).
13036
13037 Extending a back-end means that if an element type is not transcoded by the
13038 new back-end, it will be handled by the original one. Hence you can extend
13039 specific parts of a back-end without too much work.
13040
13041 As an example, imagine we want the @code{ascii} back-end to display the
13042 language used in a source block, when it is available, but only when some
13043 attribute is non-@code{nil}, like the following:
13044
13045 @example
13046 #+ATTR_ASCII: :language t
13047 @end example
13048
13049 Because that back-end is lacking in that area, we are going to create a new
13050 back-end, @code{my-ascii} that will do the job.
13051
13052 @lisp
13053 @group
13054 (defun my-ascii-src-block (src-block contents info)
13055 "Transcode a SRC-BLOCK element from Org to ASCII.
13056 CONTENTS is nil. INFO is a plist used as a communication
13057 channel."
13058 (if (not (org-export-read-attribute :attr_ascii src-block :language))
13059 (org-export-with-backend 'ascii src-block contents info)
13060 (concat
13061 (format ",--[ %s ]--\n%s`----"
13062 (org-element-property :language src-block)
13063 (replace-regexp-in-string
13064 "^" "| "
13065 (org-element-normalize-string
13066 (org-export-format-code-default src-block info)))))))
13067
13068 (org-export-define-derived-backend 'my-ascii 'ascii
13069 :translate-alist '((src-block . my-ascii-src-block)))
13070 @end group
13071 @end lisp
13072
13073 The @code{my-ascii-src-block} function looks at the attribute above the
13074 element. If it isn’t true, it gives hand to the @code{ascii} back-end.
13075 Otherwise, it creates a box around the code, leaving room for the language.
13076 A new back-end is then created. It only changes its behaviour when
13077 translating @code{src-block} type element. Now, all it takes to use the new
13078 back-end is calling the following from an Org buffer:
13079
13080 @smalllisp
13081 (org-export-to-buffer 'my-ascii "*Org MY-ASCII Export*")
13082 @end smalllisp
13083
13084 It is obviously possible to write an interactive function for this, install
13085 it in the export dispatcher menu, and so on.
13086
13087 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
13088 @chapter Publishing
13089 @cindex publishing
13090
13091 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
13092 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
13093 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
13094 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
13095 server.
13096
13097 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
13098 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
13099
13100 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
13101
13102 @menu
13103 * Configuration:: Defining projects
13104 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
13105 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
13106 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
13107 @end menu
13108
13109 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
13110 @section Configuration
13111
13112 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
13113 and many other properties of a project.
13114
13115 @menu
13116 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
13117 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
13118 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
13119 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
13120 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
13121 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
13122 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
13123 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
13124 @end menu
13125
13126 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
13127 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
13128 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
13129 @cindex projects, for publishing
13130
13131 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
13132 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
13133 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
13134 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
13135
13136 @lisp
13137 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
13138 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
13139 @r{or}
13140 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
13141
13142 @end lisp
13143
13144 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
13145 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
13146 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
13147 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
13148 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
13149 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
13150 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
13151 sequence given.
13152
13153 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
13154 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
13155 @cindex directories, for publishing
13156
13157 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
13158 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
13159 and where to put published files.
13160
13161 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
13162 @item @code{:base-directory}
13163 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
13164 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
13165 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
13166 publish to a web server using a file name syntax appropriate for
13167 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
13168 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
13169 @item @code{:preparation-function}
13170 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
13171 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
13172 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
13173 variable @code{project-plist}.
13174 @item @code{:completion-function}
13175 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
13176 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
13177 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
13178 @code{project-plist}.
13179 @end multitable
13180 @noindent
13181
13182 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
13183 @subsection Selecting files
13184 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
13185
13186 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
13187 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
13188 properties
13189 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
13190 @item @code{:base-extension}
13191 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
13192 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
13193 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
13194
13195 @item @code{:exclude}
13196 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
13197 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
13198 extension.
13199
13200 @item @code{:include}
13201 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
13202 and @code{:exclude}.
13203
13204 @item @code{:recursive}
13205 @tab non-@code{nil} means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
13206 @end multitable
13207
13208 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
13209 @subsection Publishing action
13210 @cindex action, for publishing
13211
13212 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
13213 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
13214 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
13215 @code{org-html-publish-to-html}, which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
13216 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
13217 @code{org-latex-publish-to-pdf} or as @code{ascii}, @code{Texinfo}, etc.,
13218 using the corresponding functions.
13219
13220 If you want to publish the Org file as an @code{.org} file but with the
13221 @i{archived}, @i{commented} and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use the
13222 function @code{org-org-publish-to-org}. This will produce @file{file.org}
13223 and put it in the publishing directory. If you want a htmlized version of
13224 this file, set the parameter @code{:htmlized-source} to @code{t}, it will
13225 produce @file{file.org.html} in the publishing directory@footnote{If the
13226 publishing directory is the same than the source directory, @file{file.org}
13227 will be exported as @file{file.org.org}, so probably don't want to do this.}.
13228
13229 Other files like images only need to be copied to the publishing destination.
13230 For this you can use @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-org files, you
13231 always need to specify the publishing function:
13232
13233 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
13234 @item @code{:publishing-function}
13235 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
13236 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
13237 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
13238 @tab non-@code{nil} means, publish htmlized source.
13239 @end multitable
13240
13241 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
13242 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be published
13243 and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It should take
13244 the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any) and place the
13245 result into the destination folder.
13246
13247 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
13248 @subsection Options for the exporters
13249 @cindex options, for publishing
13250
13251 The property list can be used to set many export options for the exporters.
13252 In most cases, these properties correspond to user variables in Org. The
13253 first table below lists these properties along with the variable they belong
13254 to. The second table list HTML specific properties. See the documentation
13255 string of these options for details.
13256
13257 @vindex org-display-custom-times
13258 @vindex org-export-default-language
13259 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
13260 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
13261 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
13262 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
13263 @vindex org-export-select-tags
13264 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
13265 @vindex org-export-with-author
13266 @vindex org-export-with-creator
13267 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
13268 @vindex org-export-with-email
13269 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
13270 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
13271 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
13272 @vindex org-export-with-latex
13273 @vindex org-export-with-planning
13274 @vindex org-export-with-priority
13275 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
13276 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
13277 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
13278 @vindex org-export-with-tables
13279 @vindex org-export-with-tags
13280 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
13281 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
13282 @vindex org-export-with-toc
13283 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
13284 @vindex user-mail-address
13285
13286 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
13287 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
13288 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
13289 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
13290 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
13291 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
13292 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
13293 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
13294 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
13295 @item @code{:with-author} @tab @code{org-export-with-author}
13296 @item @code{:with-creator} @tab @code{org-export-with-creator}
13297 @item @code{:with-drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
13298 @item @code{:with-email} @tab @code{org-export-with-email}
13299 @item @code{:with-emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
13300 @item @code{:with-fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
13301 @item @code{:with-footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
13302 @item @code{:with-latex} @tab @code{org-export-with-latex}
13303 @item @code{:with-planning} @tab @code{org-export-with-planning}
13304 @item @code{:with-priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
13305 @item @code{:with-special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
13306 @item @code{:with-sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
13307 @item @code{:with-tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
13308 @item @code{:with-tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
13309 @item @code{:with-tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
13310 @item @code{:with-timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
13311 @item @code{:with-toc} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
13312 @item @code{:with-todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
13313 @end multitable
13314
13315 @vindex org-html-doctype
13316 @vindex org-html-xml-declaration
13317 @vindex org-html-link-up
13318 @vindex org-html-link-home
13319 @vindex org-html-link-org-files-as-html
13320 @vindex org-html-head
13321 @vindex org-html-head-extra
13322 @vindex org-html-inline-images
13323 @vindex org-html-extension
13324 @vindex org-html-preamble
13325 @vindex org-html-postamble
13326 @vindex org-html-table-default-attributes
13327 @vindex org-html-head-include-default-style
13328 @vindex org-html-head-include-scripts
13329 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
13330 @item @code{:html-doctype} @tab @code{org-html-doctype}
13331 @item @code{:html-xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-html-xml-declaration}
13332 @item @code{:html-link-up} @tab @code{org-html-link-up}
13333 @item @code{:html-link-home} @tab @code{org-html-link-home}
13334 @item @code{:html-link-org-as-html} @tab @code{org-html-link-org-files-as-html}
13335 @item @code{:html-head} @tab @code{org-html-head}
13336 @item @code{:html-head-extra} @tab @code{org-html-head-extra}
13337 @item @code{:html-inline-images} @tab @code{org-html-inline-images}
13338 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-html-extension}
13339 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-html-preamble}
13340 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-html-postamble}
13341 @item @code{:html-table-attributes} @tab @code{org-html-table-default-attributes}
13342 @item @code{:html-head-include-default-style} @tab @code{org-html-head-include-default-style}
13343 @item @code{:html-head-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-html-head-include-scripts}
13344 @end multitable
13345
13346 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in each
13347 exporter.
13348
13349 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
13350 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist}, its
13351 setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if any)
13352 during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export settings}),
13353 however, override everything.
13354
13355 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
13356 @subsection Links between published files
13357 @cindex links, publishing
13358
13359 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something like
13360 @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply @samp{file:foo.org.}
13361 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link becomes a link to
13362 @file{foo.html}. You can thus interlink the pages of your "org web" project
13363 and the links will work as expected when you publish them to HTML@. If you
13364 also publish the Org source file and want to link to it, use an @code{http:}
13365 link instead of a @code{file:} link, because @code{file:} links are converted
13366 to link to the corresponding @file{html} file.
13367
13368 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
13369 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
13370 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
13371 an example of this usage.
13372
13373 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
13374 @subsection Generating a sitemap
13375 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
13376
13377 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
13378 a map of files for a given project.
13379
13380 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
13381 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
13382 @tab When non-@code{nil}, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
13383 or @code{org-publish-all}.
13384
13385 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
13386 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
13387 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
13388
13389 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
13390 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
13391
13392 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
13393 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
13394 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
13395 of links to all files in the project.
13396
13397 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
13398 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
13399 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
13400 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
13401
13402 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
13403 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
13404 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
13405 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
13406 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
13407 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
13408 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
13409
13410 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
13411 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
13412
13413 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
13414 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
13415 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
13416 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
13417 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
13418 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
13419 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
13420
13421 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
13422 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
13423 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
13424 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
13425
13426 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
13427 @tab When non-@code{nil}, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
13428 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
13429 Defaults to @code{nil}.
13430
13431 @end multitable
13432
13433 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
13434 @subsection Generating an index
13435 @cindex index, in a publishing project
13436
13437 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
13438
13439 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
13440 @item @code{:makeindex}
13441 @tab When non-@code{nil}, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
13442 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
13443 @end multitable
13444
13445 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
13446 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
13447 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
13448 a title, style information, etc.
13449
13450 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
13451 @section Uploading files
13452 @cindex rsync
13453 @cindex unison
13454
13455 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
13456 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
13457 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
13458 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
13459 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
13460 under heavy usage.
13461
13462 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
13463 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
13464 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
13465 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
13466 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
13467
13468 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
13469 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
13470 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
13471 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
13472 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
13473 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
13474 tool syncs them.
13475
13476 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
13477 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
13478 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
13479 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
13480 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
13481 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
13482
13483 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
13484 @section Sample configuration
13485
13486 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
13487 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
13488 more complex, with a multi-component project.
13489
13490 @menu
13491 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
13492 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
13493 @end menu
13494
13495 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
13496 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
13497
13498 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
13499 directory on the local machine.
13500
13501 @lisp
13502 (setq org-publish-project-alist
13503 '(("org"
13504 :base-directory "~/org/"
13505 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
13506 :section-numbers nil
13507 :with-toc nil
13508 :html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
13509 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
13510 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
13511 @end lisp
13512
13513 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
13514 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
13515
13516 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
13517 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
13518 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
13519 excluded.
13520
13521 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
13522 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
13523 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
13524 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
13525 @c
13526 @example
13527 file:../images/myimage.png
13528 @end example
13529 @c
13530 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
13531 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
13532 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
13533
13534 @lisp
13535 (setq org-publish-project-alist
13536 '(("orgfiles"
13537 :base-directory "~/org/"
13538 :base-extension "org"
13539 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
13540 :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html
13541 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
13542 :headline-levels 3
13543 :section-numbers nil
13544 :with-toc nil
13545 :html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
13546 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
13547 :html-preamble t)
13548
13549 ("images"
13550 :base-directory "~/images/"
13551 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
13552 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
13553 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
13554
13555 ("other"
13556 :base-directory "~/other/"
13557 :base-extension "css\\|el"
13558 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
13559 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
13560 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
13561 @end lisp
13562
13563 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
13564 @section Triggering publication
13565
13566 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
13567
13568 @table @kbd
13569 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P x,org-publish}
13570 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
13571 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P p,org-publish-current-project}
13572 Publish the project containing the current file.
13573 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P f,org-publish-current-file}
13574 Publish only the current file.
13575 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P a,org-publish-all}
13576 Publish every project.
13577 @end table
13578
13579 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
13580 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
13581 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
13582 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
13583 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
13584 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
13585 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
13586
13587 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13588 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
13589
13590 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
13591 @chapter Working with source code
13592 @cindex Schulte, Eric
13593 @cindex Davison, Dan
13594 @cindex source code, working with
13595
13596 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
13597 e.g.:
13598
13599 @example
13600 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13601 (defun org-xor (a b)
13602 "Exclusive or."
13603 (if a (not b) b))
13604 #+END_SRC
13605 @end example
13606
13607 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
13608 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
13609 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
13610 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
13611 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
13612 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
13613
13614 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
13615
13616 @menu
13617 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
13618 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
13619 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
13620 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
13621 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
13622 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
13623 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
13624 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
13625 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
13626 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
13627 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
13628 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
13629 @end menu
13630
13631 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13632 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
13633
13634 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
13635 @section Structure of code blocks
13636 @cindex code block, structure
13637 @cindex source code, block structure
13638 @cindex #+NAME
13639 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
13640
13641 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
13642 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
13643 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
13644
13645 @example
13646 #+NAME: <name>
13647 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
13648 <body>
13649 #+END_SRC
13650 @end example
13651
13652 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
13653 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
13654 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
13655 @cindex source code, inline
13656
13657 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
13658
13659 @example
13660 src_<language>@{<body>@}
13661 @end example
13662
13663 or
13664
13665 @example
13666 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
13667 @end example
13668
13669 @table @code
13670 @item <#+NAME: name>
13671 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
13672 @code{#+NAME: Name} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
13673 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
13674 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
13675 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
13676 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
13677 undefined.
13678 @cindex #+NAME
13679 @item <language>
13680 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
13681 @cindex source code, language
13682 @item <switches>
13683 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
13684 @ref{Literal examples})
13685 @cindex source code, switches
13686 @item <header arguments>
13687 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
13688 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
13689 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
13690 basis using properties.
13691 @item source code, header arguments
13692 @item <body>
13693 Source code in the specified language.
13694 @end table
13695
13696 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13697 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
13698
13699 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
13700 @section Editing source code
13701 @cindex code block, editing
13702 @cindex source code, editing
13703
13704 @vindex org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay
13705 @vindex org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save
13706 @kindex C-c '
13707 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up a language
13708 major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code block. Manually
13709 saving this buffer with @key{C-x C-s} will write the contents back to the Org
13710 buffer. You can also set @code{org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay} to save the
13711 base buffer after some idle delay, or @code{org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save}
13712 to auto-save this buffer into a separate file using @code{auto-save-mode}.
13713 Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
13714
13715 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
13716 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
13717 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
13718 further configuration options.
13719
13720 @table @code
13721 @item org-src-lang-modes
13722 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
13723 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
13724 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
13725 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
13726 @item org-src-window-setup
13727 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
13728 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
13729 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
13730 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
13731 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
13732 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
13733 variable to @code{nil} to switch without asking.
13734 @end table
13735
13736 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
13737 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
13738
13739 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13740 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
13741
13742 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
13743 @section Exporting code blocks
13744 @cindex code block, exporting
13745 @cindex source code, exporting
13746
13747 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
13748 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
13749 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
13750 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
13751 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
13752 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
13753
13754 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
13755 behavior:
13756
13757 @subsubheading Header arguments:
13758
13759 @table @code
13760 @item :exports code
13761 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
13762 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
13763 @item :exports results
13764 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
13765 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
13766 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
13767 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
13768 block will not be exported.
13769 @item :exports both
13770 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
13771 @item :exports none
13772 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
13773 @end table
13774
13775 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
13776 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
13777 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
13778 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
13779 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
13780 markup language for a wiki. It is also possible to set this variable to
13781 @code{‘inline-only}. In that case, only inline code blocks will be
13782 evaluated, in order to insert their results. Non-inline code blocks are
13783 assumed to have their results already inserted in the buffer by manual
13784 evaluation. This setting is useful to avoid expensive recalculations during
13785 export, not to provide security.
13786
13787 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13788 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
13789 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
13790 @section Extracting source code
13791 @cindex tangling
13792 @cindex source code, extracting
13793 @cindex code block, extracting source code
13794
13795 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
13796 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
13797 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
13798 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
13799 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
13800
13801 @subsubheading Header arguments
13802
13803 @table @code
13804 @item :tangle no
13805 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
13806 @item :tangle yes
13807 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
13808 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
13809 for the block language.
13810 @item :tangle filename
13811 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
13812 @end table
13813
13814 @kindex C-c C-v t
13815 @subsubheading Functions
13816
13817 @table @code
13818 @item org-babel-tangle
13819 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
13820
13821 With prefix argument only tangle the current code block.
13822 @item org-babel-tangle-file
13823 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
13824 @end table
13825
13826 @subsubheading Hooks
13827
13828 @table @code
13829 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
13830 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
13831 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
13832 of tangled code files.
13833 @end table
13834
13835 @subsubheading Jumping between code and Org
13836
13837 When tangling code from an Org-mode buffer to a source code file, you'll
13838 frequently find yourself viewing the file of tangled source code (e.g., many
13839 debuggers point to lines of the source code file). It is useful to be able
13840 to navigate from the tangled source to the Org-mode buffer from which the
13841 code originated.
13842
13843 The @code{org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org} function provides this jumping from
13844 code to Org-mode functionality. Two header arguments are required for
13845 jumping to work, first the @code{padline} (@ref{padline}) option must be set
13846 to true (the default setting), second the @code{comments} (@ref{comments})
13847 header argument must be set to @code{links}, which will insert comments into
13848 the source code buffer which point back to the original Org-mode file.
13849
13850 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
13851 @section Evaluating code blocks
13852 @cindex code block, evaluating
13853 @cindex source code, evaluating
13854 @cindex #+RESULTS
13855
13856 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
13857 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
13858 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
13859 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
13860 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
13861 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
13862 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
13863 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
13864 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
13865 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
13866
13867 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
13868 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
13869 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
13870 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
13871 used to define a code block).
13872
13873 @kindex C-c C-c
13874 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
13875 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
13876 option @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} can be used to remove code
13877 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
13878 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
13879 its results into the Org mode buffer.
13880 @cindex #+CALL
13881
13882 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
13883 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
13884 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
13885 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
13886 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
13887
13888 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
13889
13890 @example
13891 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
13892 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
13893 @end example
13894
13895 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
13896
13897 @example
13898 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
13899 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
13900 @end example
13901
13902 @table @code
13903 @item <name>
13904 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
13905 @item <arguments>
13906 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
13907 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
13908 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
13909 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
13910 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
13911 @item <inside header arguments>
13912 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
13913 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
13914 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
13915 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
13916 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
13917 @item <end header arguments>
13918 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
13919 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
13920 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
13921 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
13922 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
13923
13924 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13925 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13926 @end table
13927
13928 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13929 @section Library of Babel
13930 @cindex babel, library of
13931 @cindex source code, library
13932 @cindex code block, library
13933
13934 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13935 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13936 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13937 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13938
13939
13940 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13941 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13942
13943 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13944 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13945 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13946
13947
13948 @kindex C-c C-v i
13949 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13950 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13951 i}.
13952
13953 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13954 @section Languages
13955 @cindex babel, languages
13956 @cindex source code, languages
13957 @cindex code block, languages
13958
13959 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13960
13961 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13962 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13963 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13964 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13965 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13966 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13967 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13968 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13969 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13970 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13971 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13972 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13973 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13974 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13975 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13976 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13977 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13978 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13979 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13980 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13981 @end multitable
13982
13983 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13984 available, it can be found at
13985 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13986
13987 The option @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are
13988 enabled for evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This
13989 variable can be set using the customization interface or by adding code like
13990 the following to your emacs configuration.
13991
13992 @quotation
13993 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13994 @code{R} code blocks.
13995 @end quotation
13996
13997 @lisp
13998 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13999 'org-babel-load-languages
14000 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
14001 (R . t)))
14002 @end lisp
14003
14004 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
14005 elisp file with @code{require}.
14006
14007 @quotation
14008 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
14009 @end quotation
14010
14011 @lisp
14012 (require 'ob-clojure)
14013 @end lisp
14014
14015 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
14016 @section Header arguments
14017 @cindex code block, header arguments
14018 @cindex source code, block header arguments
14019
14020 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
14021 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
14022 describes each header argument in detail.
14023
14024 @menu
14025 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
14026 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
14027 @end menu
14028
14029 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
14030 @subsection Using header arguments
14031
14032 The values of header arguments can be set in several way. When the header
14033 arguments in each layer have been determined, they are combined in order from
14034 the first, least specific (having the lowest priority) up to the last, most
14035 specific (having the highest priority). A header argument with a higher
14036 priority replaces the same header argument specified at lower priority.
14037 @menu
14038 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
14039 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
14040 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
14041 * Language-specific header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set language-specific default values for a buffer or heading
14042 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
14043 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
14044 @end menu
14045
14046
14047 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
14048 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
14049 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
14050 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by adapting the
14051 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
14052
14053 @example
14054 :session => "none"
14055 :results => "replace"
14056 :exports => "code"
14057 :cache => "no"
14058 :noweb => "no"
14059 @end example
14060
14061 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
14062 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
14063 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
14064 blocks.
14065
14066 @lisp
14067 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
14068 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
14069 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
14070 @end lisp
14071
14072 @node Language-specific header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
14073 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
14074 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments in variable
14075 @code{org-babel-default-header-args:<lang>}, where @code{<lang>} is the name
14076 of the language. See the language-specific documentation available online at
14077 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
14078
14079 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
14080 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
14081
14082 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
14083 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
14084 @ref{Property syntax}).
14085
14086 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*} (only for R
14087 code blocks), and @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the
14088 buffer, ensuring that all execution took place in the same session, and no
14089 results would be inserted into the buffer.
14090
14091 @example
14092 #+PROPERTY: header-args:R :session *R*
14093 #+PROPERTY: header-args :results silent
14094 @end example
14095
14096 Header arguments read from Org mode properties can also be set on a
14097 per-subtree basis using property drawers (see @ref{Property syntax}).
14098 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14099 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are always
14100 looked up with inheritance, regardless of the value of
14101 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. Properties are evaluated as seen by the
14102 outermost call or source block.@footnote{The deprecated syntax for default
14103 header argument properties, using the name of the header argument as a
14104 property name directly, evaluates the property as seen by the corresponding
14105 source block definition. This behaviour has been kept for backwards
14106 compatibility.}
14107
14108 In the following example the value of
14109 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
14110 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
14111
14112 @example
14113 * outline header
14114 :PROPERTIES:
14115 :header-args: :cache yes
14116 :END:
14117 @end example
14118
14119 @kindex C-c C-x p
14120 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
14121 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
14122 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and are applied for all activated
14123 languages. It is convenient to use the @code{org-set-property} function
14124 bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties in Org mode documents.
14125
14126 @node Language-specific header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
14127 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments in Org mode properties
14128
14129 Language-specific header arguments are also read from properties
14130 @code{header-args:<lang>} where @code{<lang>} is the name of the language
14131 targeted. As an example
14132
14133 @example
14134 * Heading
14135 :PROPERTIES:
14136 :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-1*
14137 :header-args:R: :session *R*
14138 :END:
14139 ** Subheading
14140 :PROPERTIES:
14141 :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-2*
14142 :END:
14143 @end example
14144
14145 would independently set a default session header argument for R and clojure
14146 for calls and source blocks under subtree ``Heading'' and change to a
14147 different clojure setting for evaluations under subtree ``Subheading'', while
14148 the R session is inherited from ``Heading'' and therefore unchanged.
14149
14150 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Language-specific header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
14151 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
14152
14153 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
14154 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
14155 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
14156 Properties set in this way override both the values of
14157 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
14158 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
14159 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
14160 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
14161 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
14162 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
14163
14164 @example
14165 #+NAME: factorial
14166 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
14167 fac 0 = 1
14168 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
14169 #+END_SRC
14170 @end example
14171 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
14172
14173 @example
14174 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
14175 @end example
14176
14177 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
14178 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
14179 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
14180 @cindex #+HEADER:
14181 @cindex #+HEADERS:
14182
14183 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
14184
14185 @example
14186 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
14187 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
14188 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
14189 #+END_SRC
14190
14191 #+RESULTS:
14192 : data1:1, data2:2
14193 @end example
14194
14195 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
14196
14197 @example
14198 #+NAME: named-block
14199 #+HEADER: :var data=2
14200 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
14201 (message "data:%S" data)
14202 #+END_SRC
14203
14204 #+RESULTS: named-block
14205 : data:2
14206 @end example
14207
14208 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
14209 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
14210 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
14211
14212 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
14213 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
14214 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
14215 blocks}.
14216
14217 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
14218 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
14219
14220 @example
14221 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
14222 @end example
14223
14224 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
14225 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
14226
14227 @example
14228 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
14229 @end example
14230
14231 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
14232 @subsection Specific header arguments
14233 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
14234 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
14235
14236 @menu
14237 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
14238 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
14239 be collected and handled
14240 * file:: Specify a path for file output
14241 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
14242 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
14243 directory for code block execution
14244 * exports:: Export code and/or results
14245 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
14246 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
14247 files during tangling
14248 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
14249 code files
14250 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
14251 code files
14252 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
14253 expansion during tangling
14254 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
14255 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
14256 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
14257 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
14258 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
14259 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
14260 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
14261 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
14262 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
14263 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
14264 * tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files
14265 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
14266 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
14267 * post:: Post processing of code block results
14268 * prologue:: Text to prepend to code block body
14269 * epilogue:: Text to append to code block body
14270 @end menu
14271
14272 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
14273 @ref{Languages}.
14274
14275 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
14276 @subsubsection @code{:var}
14277 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
14278 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
14279 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
14280 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
14281 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
14282
14283 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
14284 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}).
14285 References include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:}
14286 or @code{#+RESULTS:} line: tables, lists, @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks,
14287 other code blocks and the results of other code blocks.
14288
14289 Note: When a reference is made to another code block, the referenced block
14290 will be evaluated unless it has current cached results (see @ref{cache}).
14291
14292 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
14293 Indexable variable values}).
14294
14295 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
14296 @code{:var} header argument.
14297
14298 @example
14299 :var name=assign
14300 @end example
14301
14302 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
14303 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
14304 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
14305 results of evaluating another code block.
14306
14307 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
14308
14309 @table @dfn
14310
14311 @item table
14312 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} line
14313
14314 @example
14315 #+NAME: example-table
14316 | 1 |
14317 | 2 |
14318 | 3 |
14319 | 4 |
14320
14321 #+NAME: table-length
14322 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
14323 (length table)
14324 #+END_SRC
14325
14326 #+RESULTS: table-length
14327 : 4
14328 @end example
14329
14330 @item list
14331 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
14332 carried through to the source code block)
14333
14334 @example
14335 #+NAME: example-list
14336 - simple
14337 - not
14338 - nested
14339 - list
14340
14341 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
14342 (print x)
14343 #+END_SRC
14344
14345 #+RESULTS:
14346 | simple | list |
14347 @end example
14348
14349 @item code block without arguments
14350 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
14351 optionally followed by parentheses
14352
14353 @example
14354 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
14355 (* 2 length)
14356 #+END_SRC
14357
14358 #+RESULTS:
14359 : 8
14360 @end example
14361
14362 @item code block with arguments
14363 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
14364 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
14365 code block name using standard function call syntax
14366
14367 @example
14368 #+NAME: double
14369 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
14370 (* 2 input)
14371 #+END_SRC
14372
14373 #+RESULTS: double
14374 : 16
14375
14376 #+NAME: squared
14377 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
14378 (* input input)
14379 #+END_SRC
14380
14381 #+RESULTS: squared
14382 : 4
14383 @end example
14384
14385 @item literal example
14386 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
14387
14388 @example
14389 #+NAME: literal-example
14390 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
14391 A literal example
14392 on two lines
14393 #+END_EXAMPLE
14394
14395 #+NAME: read-literal-example
14396 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
14397 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
14398 #+END_SRC
14399
14400 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
14401 : A literal example
14402 : on two lines for you.
14403
14404 @end example
14405
14406 @end table
14407
14408 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
14409 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
14410 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
14411 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
14412 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
14413 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
14414 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
14415 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
14416 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
14417
14418 @example
14419 #+NAME: example-table
14420 | 1 | a |
14421 | 2 | b |
14422 | 3 | c |
14423 | 4 | d |
14424
14425 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
14426 data
14427 #+END_SRC
14428
14429 #+RESULTS:
14430 : a
14431 @end example
14432
14433 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
14434 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
14435 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
14436 to @code{data}.
14437
14438 @example
14439 #+NAME: example-table
14440 | 1 | a |
14441 | 2 | b |
14442 | 3 | c |
14443 | 4 | d |
14444 | 5 | 3 |
14445
14446 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
14447 data
14448 #+END_SRC
14449
14450 #+RESULTS:
14451 | 2 | b |
14452 | 3 | c |
14453 | 4 | d |
14454 @end example
14455
14456 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
14457 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
14458 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
14459 column is referenced.
14460
14461 @example
14462 #+NAME: example-table
14463 | 1 | a |
14464 | 2 | b |
14465 | 3 | c |
14466 | 4 | d |
14467
14468 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
14469 data
14470 #+END_SRC
14471
14472 #+RESULTS:
14473 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
14474 @end example
14475
14476 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
14477 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
14478 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
14479
14480 @example
14481 #+NAME: 3D
14482 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
14483 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
14484 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
14485 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
14486 #+END_SRC
14487
14488 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
14489 data
14490 #+END_SRC
14491
14492 #+RESULTS:
14493 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
14494 @end example
14495
14496 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
14497
14498 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
14499 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
14500 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
14501 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
14502 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
14503 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
14504 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
14505 evaluation of the code block body.
14506
14507 @example
14508 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
14509 wc -w $filename
14510 #+END_SRC
14511 @end example
14512
14513 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
14514 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
14515
14516 @example
14517 #+NAME: table
14518 | (a b c) |
14519
14520 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
14521 #+BEGIN_SRC perl
14522 $data
14523 #+END_SRC
14524
14525 #+RESULTS:
14526 : (a b c)
14527 @end example
14528
14529 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
14530 @subsubsection @code{:results}
14531
14532 There are four classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
14533 per class may be supplied per code block.
14534
14535 @itemize @bullet
14536 @item
14537 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
14538 from the code block
14539 @item
14540 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
14541 return---which has implications for how they will be processed before
14542 insertion into the Org mode buffer
14543 @item
14544 @b{format} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
14545 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
14546 Org mode buffer
14547 @item
14548 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
14549 block should be handled.
14550 @end itemize
14551
14552 @subsubheading Collection
14553 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
14554 should be collected from the code block.
14555
14556 @itemize @bullet
14557 @item @code{value}
14558 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
14559 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
14560 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
14561 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
14562 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
14563 @item @code{output}
14564 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
14565 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
14566 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
14567 @end itemize
14568
14569 @subsubheading Type
14570
14571 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
14572 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
14573 table or scalar depending on their value.
14574
14575 @itemize @bullet
14576 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
14577 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
14578 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
14579 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
14580 @item @code{list}
14581 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
14582 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
14583 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
14584 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
14585 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
14586 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
14587 @item @code{file}
14588 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
14589 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
14590 @end itemize
14591
14592 @subsubheading Format
14593
14594 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
14595 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted according to the
14596 type as specified above.
14597
14598 @itemize @bullet
14599 @item @code{raw}
14600 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
14601 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
14602 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
14603 @item @code{org}
14604 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
14605 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
14606 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
14607 @item @code{html}
14608 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
14609 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
14610 @item @code{latex}
14611 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
14612 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
14613 @item @code{code}
14614 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
14615 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
14616 @item @code{pp}
14617 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
14618 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
14619 @code{:results value pp}.
14620 @item @code{drawer}
14621 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
14622 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
14623 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
14624 @end itemize
14625
14626 @subsubheading Handling
14627 The following results options indicate what happens with the
14628 results once they are collected.
14629
14630 @itemize @bullet
14631 @item @code{silent}
14632 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
14633 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
14634 @item @code{replace}
14635 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
14636 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
14637 @code{:results output replace}.
14638 @item @code{append}
14639 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
14640 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
14641 inserted as with @code{replace}.
14642 @item @code{prepend}
14643 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
14644 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
14645 inserted as with @code{replace}.
14646 @end itemize
14647
14648 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
14649 @subsubsection @code{:file}
14650
14651 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
14652 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
14653 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
14654 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
14655 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
14656 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
14657 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
14658 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
14659
14660 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
14661 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
14662 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
14663
14664 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
14665 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
14666
14667 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
14668 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
14669 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
14670 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
14671 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
14672
14673 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
14674 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
14675
14676 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
14677 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
14678 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
14679 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
14680 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path RET}, and
14681 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
14682 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
14683
14684 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
14685 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
14686 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
14687
14688 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
14689 in your home directory, you could use
14690
14691 @example
14692 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
14693 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
14694 #+END_SRC
14695 @end example
14696
14697 @subsubheading Remote execution
14698 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
14699 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
14700
14701 @example
14702 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
14703 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
14704 #+END_SRC
14705 @end example
14706
14707 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
14708 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
14709 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
14710 created.
14711
14712 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
14713 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
14714
14715 @example
14716 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
14717 @end example
14718
14719 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
14720 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
14721 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
14722 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
14723
14724 @subsubheading Further points
14725
14726 @itemize @bullet
14727 @item
14728 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
14729 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
14730 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
14731 @item
14732 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
14733 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
14734 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
14735 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
14736 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
14737 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
14738 which the link does not point.
14739 @end itemize
14740
14741 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
14742 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
14743
14744 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
14745 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
14746
14747 @itemize @bullet
14748 @item @code{code}
14749 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
14750 @code{:exports code}.
14751 @item @code{results}
14752 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
14753 @code{:exports results}.
14754 @item @code{both}
14755 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
14756 @code{:exports both}.
14757 @item @code{none}
14758 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
14759 @end itemize
14760
14761 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
14762 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
14763
14764 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
14765 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
14766
14767 @itemize @bullet
14768 @item @code{tangle}
14769 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
14770 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
14771 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
14772 @item @code{no}
14773 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
14774 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
14775 @item other
14776 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
14777 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
14778 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
14779 @end itemize
14780
14781 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
14782 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
14783
14784 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
14785 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
14786 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
14787
14788 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
14789 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
14790 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
14791 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
14792 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
14793 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
14794
14795 @itemize @bullet
14796 @item @code{no}
14797 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
14798 @item @code{link}
14799 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
14800 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
14801 @item @code{yes}
14802 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
14803 @item @code{org}
14804 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
14805 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
14806 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
14807 @item @code{both}
14808 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
14809 @item @code{noweb}
14810 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
14811 references in the code block body in link comments.
14812 @end itemize
14813
14814 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
14815 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
14816 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
14817 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
14818 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
14819 are accepted.
14820
14821 @itemize @bullet
14822 @item @code{yes}
14823 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
14824 @item @code{no}
14825 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
14826 @end itemize
14827
14828 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
14829 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
14830
14831 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14832 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
14833 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
14834 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
14835 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
14836
14837 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
14838 @subsubsection @code{:session}
14839
14840 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
14841 language where state is preserved.
14842
14843 By default, a session is not started.
14844
14845 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
14846 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
14847 interpreted language.
14848
14849 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
14850 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
14851
14852 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
14853 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
14854 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
14855 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
14856 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
14857
14858 @itemize @bullet
14859 @item @code{no}
14860 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
14861 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
14862 @item @code{yes}
14863 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
14864 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
14865 @item @code{tangle}
14866 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
14867 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
14868 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
14869 @item @code{no-export}
14870 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
14871 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
14872 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
14873 @item @code{strip-export}
14874 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
14875 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
14876 references will be removed when the code block is exported.
14877 @item @code{eval}
14878 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
14879 expanded before the block is evaluated.
14880 @end itemize
14881
14882 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
14883 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
14884 @code{<<reference>>}.
14885 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
14886 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
14887 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
14888
14889 This code block:
14890
14891 @example
14892 -- <<example>>
14893 @end example
14894
14895 expands to:
14896
14897 @example
14898 -- this is the
14899 -- multi-line body of example
14900 @end example
14901
14902 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
14903 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
14904 references.
14905
14906 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
14907 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
14908 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
14909 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
14910 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
14911 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
14912
14913 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
14914 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
14915 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
14916 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
14917 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
14918 inheritance}).}.
14919
14920 @example
14921 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
14922 <<fullest-disk>>
14923 #+END_SRC
14924 * the mount point of the fullest disk
14925 :PROPERTIES:
14926 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
14927 :END:
14928
14929 ** query all mounted disks
14930 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14931 df \
14932 #+END_SRC
14933
14934 ** strip the header row
14935 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14936 |sed '1d' \
14937 #+END_SRC
14938
14939 ** sort by the percent full
14940 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14941 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
14942 #+END_SRC
14943
14944 ** extract the mount point
14945 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14946 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14947 #+END_SRC
14948 @end example
14949
14950 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14951 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14952 newline is used.
14953
14954 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14955 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14956
14957 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14958 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14959 used.
14960
14961 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14962 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14963
14964 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14965 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14966 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14967 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14968 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14969 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14970 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14971
14972 @itemize @bullet
14973 @item @code{no}
14974 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14975 every time it is called.
14976 @item @code{yes}
14977 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14978 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14979 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14980 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14981 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14982 @end itemize
14983
14984 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14985 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14986 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14987 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14988 changed since it was last run.
14989
14990 @example
14991 #+NAME: random
14992 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14993 runif(1)
14994 #+END_SRC
14995
14996 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14997 0.4659510825295
14998
14999 #+NAME: caller
15000 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
15001 x
15002 #+END_SRC
15003
15004 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
15005 0.254227238707244
15006 @end example
15007
15008 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
15009 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
15010
15011 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
15012 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
15013 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
15014 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
15015 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
15016 header argument.
15017
15018 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
15019 delimited.
15020
15021 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
15022 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
15023
15024 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
15025 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
15026 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
15027
15028 @itemize @bullet
15029 @item @code{no}
15030 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
15031 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
15032 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
15033 default value yields the following results.
15034
15035 @example
15036 #+NAME: many-cols
15037 | a | b | c |
15038 |---+---+---|
15039 | d | e | f |
15040 |---+---+---|
15041 | g | h | i |
15042
15043 #+NAME: echo-table
15044 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
15045 return tab
15046 #+END_SRC
15047
15048 #+RESULTS: echo-table
15049 | a | b | c |
15050 | d | e | f |
15051 | g | h | i |
15052 @end example
15053
15054 @item @code{yes}
15055 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
15056
15057 @example
15058 #+NAME: many-cols
15059 | a | b | c |
15060 |---+---+---|
15061 | d | e | f |
15062 |---+---+---|
15063 | g | h | i |
15064
15065 #+NAME: echo-table
15066 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
15067 return tab
15068 #+END_SRC
15069
15070 #+RESULTS: echo-table
15071 | a | b | c |
15072 |---+---+---|
15073 | d | e | f |
15074 |---+---+---|
15075 | g | h | i |
15076 @end example
15077 @end itemize
15078
15079 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
15080 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
15081
15082 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
15083 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
15084 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
15085 across languages.
15086
15087 @itemize @bullet
15088 @item @code{nil}
15089 If an input table looks like it has column names
15090 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
15091 names will be removed from the table before
15092 processing, then reapplied to the results.
15093
15094 @example
15095 #+NAME: less-cols
15096 | a |
15097 |---|
15098 | b |
15099 | c |
15100
15101 #+NAME: echo-table-again
15102 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
15103 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
15104 #+END_SRC
15105
15106 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
15107 | a |
15108 |----|
15109 | b* |
15110 | c* |
15111 @end example
15112
15113 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
15114 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
15115
15116 @item @code{no}
15117 No column name pre-processing takes place
15118
15119 @item @code{yes}
15120 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
15121 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
15122 hline)
15123 @end itemize
15124
15125 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
15126 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
15127
15128 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes} or
15129 @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}. Note that Emacs Lisp code
15130 blocks ignore the @code{:rownames} header argument entirely given the ease
15131 with which tables with row names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
15132
15133 @itemize @bullet
15134 @item @code{no}
15135 No row name pre-processing will take place.
15136
15137 @item @code{yes}
15138 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
15139 and is then reapplied to the results.
15140
15141 @example
15142 #+NAME: with-rownames
15143 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
15144 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
15145
15146 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
15147 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
15148 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
15149 #+END_SRC
15150
15151 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
15152 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
15153 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
15154 @end example
15155
15156 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
15157 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
15158
15159 @end itemize
15160
15161 @node shebang, tangle-mode, rownames, Specific header arguments
15162 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
15163
15164 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
15165 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
15166 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
15167 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
15168
15169
15170 @node tangle-mode, eval, shebang, Specific header arguments
15171 @subsubsection @code{:tangle-mode}
15172
15173 The @code{tangle-mode} header argument controls the permission set on tangled
15174 files. The value of this header argument will be passed to
15175 @code{set-file-modes}. For example, to set a tangled file as read only use
15176 @code{:tangle-mode (identity #o444)}, or to set a tangled file as executable
15177 use @code{:tangle-mode (identity #o755)}. Blocks with @code{shebang}
15178 (@ref{shebang}) header arguments will automatically be made executable unless
15179 the @code{tangle-mode} header argument is also used. The behavior is
15180 undefined if multiple code blocks with different values for the
15181 @code{tangle-mode} header argument are tangled to the same file.
15182
15183 @node eval, wrap, tangle-mode, Specific header arguments
15184 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
15185 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
15186 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
15187 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
15188 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
15189 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
15190 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
15191
15192 @table @code
15193 @item never or no
15194 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
15195 @item query
15196 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
15197 @item never-export or no-export
15198 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
15199 interactively.
15200 @item query-export
15201 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
15202 @end table
15203
15204 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
15205 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
15206 security}.
15207
15208 @node wrap, post, eval, Specific header arguments
15209 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
15210 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
15211 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
15212 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
15213 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
15214 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
15215
15216 @node post, prologue, wrap, Specific header arguments
15217 @subsubsection @code{:post}
15218 The @code{:post} header argument is used to post-process the results of a
15219 code block execution. When a post argument is given, the results of the code
15220 block will temporarily be bound to the @code{*this*} variable. This variable
15221 may then be included in header argument forms such as those used in @ref{var}
15222 header argument specifications allowing passing of results to other code
15223 blocks, or direct execution via Emacs Lisp.
15224
15225 The following example illustrates the usage of the @code{:post} header
15226 argument.
15227
15228 @example
15229 #+name: attr_wrap
15230 #+begin_src sh :var data="" :var width="\\textwidth" :results output
15231 echo "#+ATTR_LATEX :width $width"
15232 echo "$data"
15233 #+end_src
15234
15235 #+header: :file /tmp/it.png
15236 #+begin_src dot :post attr_wrap(width="5cm", data=*this*) :results drawer
15237 digraph@{
15238 a -> b;
15239 b -> c;
15240 c -> a;
15241 @}
15242 #+end_src
15243
15244 #+RESULTS:
15245 :RESULTS:
15246 #+ATTR_LATEX :width 5cm
15247 [[file:/tmp/it.png]]
15248 :END:
15249 @end example
15250
15251 @node prologue, epilogue, post, Specific header arguments
15252 @subsubsection @code{:prologue}
15253 The value of the @code{prologue} header argument will be prepended to the
15254 code block body before execution. For example, @code{:prologue "reset"} may
15255 be used to reset a gnuplot session before execution of a particular code
15256 block, or the following configuration may be used to do this for all gnuplot
15257 code blocks. Also see @ref{epilogue}.
15258
15259 @lisp
15260 (add-to-list 'org-babel-default-header-args:gnuplot
15261 '((:prologue . "reset")))
15262 @end lisp
15263
15264 @node epilogue, , prologue, Specific header arguments
15265 @subsubsection @code{:epilogue}
15266 The value of the @code{epilogue} header argument will be appended to the code
15267 block body before execution. Also see @ref{prologue}.
15268
15269 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
15270 @section Results of evaluation
15271 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
15272 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
15273
15274 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
15275 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
15276 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
15277 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
15278
15279 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
15280 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
15281 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
15282 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
15283 @end multitable
15284
15285 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
15286 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
15287 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
15288
15289 @subsection Non-session
15290 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
15291 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
15292 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
15293 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
15294 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
15295 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
15296 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
15297
15298 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
15299 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
15300
15301 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
15302 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
15303 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
15304 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
15305 future work.)
15306
15307 @subsection Session
15308 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
15309 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
15310 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
15311 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
15312 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
15313 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
15314 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
15315 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
15316
15317 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
15318 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
15319 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
15320 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
15321 in R).
15322
15323 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
15324 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
15325 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
15326 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
15327 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
15328 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
15329 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
15330
15331 @example
15332 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
15333 print "hello"
15334 2
15335 print "bye"
15336 #+END_SRC
15337
15338 #+RESULTS:
15339 : hello
15340 : bye
15341 @end example
15342
15343 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
15344
15345 @example
15346 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
15347 print "hello"
15348 2
15349 print "bye"
15350 #+END_SRC
15351
15352 #+RESULTS:
15353 : hello
15354 : 2
15355 : bye
15356 @end example
15357
15358 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
15359 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
15360 unnecessary here).
15361
15362 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
15363 @section Noweb reference syntax
15364 @cindex code block, noweb reference
15365 @cindex syntax, noweb
15366 @cindex source code, noweb reference
15367
15368 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
15369 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
15370 familiar Noweb syntax:
15371
15372 @example
15373 <<code-block-name>>
15374 @end example
15375
15376 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
15377 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
15378 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
15379 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
15380 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
15381 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
15382
15383 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
15384 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
15385 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
15386
15387 @example
15388 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
15389 @end example
15390
15391 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
15392 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
15393 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
15394 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
15395 the default value.
15396
15397 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
15398 @code{org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion} variable to @code{t}.
15399 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
15400 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
15401 argument.
15402
15403 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
15404 @section Key bindings and useful functions
15405 @cindex code block, key bindings
15406
15407 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
15408 the context.
15409
15410 Within a code block, the following key bindings
15411 are active:
15412
15413 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
15414 @kindex C-c C-c
15415 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
15416 @kindex C-c C-o
15417 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
15418 @kindex C-up
15419 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
15420 @kindex M-down
15421 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
15422 @end multitable
15423
15424 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
15425
15426 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
15427 @kindex C-c C-v p
15428 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
15429 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
15430 @kindex C-c C-v n
15431 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
15432 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
15433 @kindex C-c C-v e
15434 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
15435 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
15436 @kindex C-c C-v o
15437 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
15438 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
15439 @kindex C-c C-v v
15440 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
15441 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
15442 @kindex C-c C-v u
15443 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
15444 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
15445 @kindex C-c C-v g
15446 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
15447 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
15448 @kindex C-c C-v r
15449 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
15450 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
15451 @kindex C-c C-v b
15452 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
15453 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
15454 @kindex C-c C-v s
15455 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
15456 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
15457 @kindex C-c C-v d
15458 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
15459 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
15460 @kindex C-c C-v t
15461 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
15462 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
15463 @kindex C-c C-v f
15464 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
15465 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
15466 @kindex C-c C-v c
15467 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
15468 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
15469 @kindex C-c C-v j
15470 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
15471 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
15472 @kindex C-c C-v l
15473 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
15474 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
15475 @kindex C-c C-v i
15476 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
15477 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
15478 @kindex C-c C-v I
15479 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
15480 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
15481 @kindex C-c C-v z
15482 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
15483 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
15484 @kindex C-c C-v a
15485 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
15486 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
15487 @kindex C-c C-v h
15488 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
15489 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
15490 @kindex C-c C-v x
15491 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
15492 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
15493 @end multitable
15494
15495 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
15496 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
15497
15498 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
15499 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
15500 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
15501 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
15502 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
15503 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
15504 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
15505 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
15506 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
15507 @c @end multitable
15508
15509 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
15510 @section Batch execution
15511 @cindex code block, batch execution
15512 @cindex source code, batch execution
15513
15514 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
15515 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
15516
15517 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
15518
15519 @example
15520 #!/bin/sh
15521 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
15522 #
15523 # tangle files with org-mode
15524 #
15525 DIR=`pwd`
15526 FILES=""
15527
15528 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
15529 for i in $@@; do
15530 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
15531 done
15532
15533 emacs -Q --batch \
15534 --eval "(progn
15535 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
15536 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
15537 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
15538 (mapc (lambda (file)
15539 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
15540 (org-babel-tangle)
15541 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
15542 @end example
15543
15544 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
15545 @chapter Miscellaneous
15546
15547 @menu
15548 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
15549 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
15550 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
15551 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
15552 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
15553 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
15554 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
15555 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
15556 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
15557 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
15558 * org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files
15559 @end menu
15560
15561
15562 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
15563 @section Completion
15564 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
15565 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
15566 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
15567 @cindex completion, of option keywords
15568 @cindex completion, of tags
15569 @cindex completion, of property keys
15570 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
15571 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
15572 @cindex TODO keywords completion
15573 @cindex dictionary word completion
15574 @cindex option keyword completion
15575 @cindex tag completion
15576 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
15577
15578 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
15579 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
15580 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
15581 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
15582 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
15583
15584 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
15585 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
15586 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
15587
15588 @table @kbd
15589 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
15590 @item M-@key{TAB}
15591 Complete word at point
15592 @itemize @bullet
15593 @item
15594 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
15595 @item
15596 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
15597 @item
15598 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
15599 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
15600 @item
15601 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
15602 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
15603 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
15604 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
15605 @item
15606 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
15607 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
15608 buffer.
15609 @item
15610 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
15611 @item
15612 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
15613 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
15614 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
15615 will insert example settings for this keyword.
15616 @item
15617 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
15618 i.e., valid keys for this line.
15619 @item
15620 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
15621 @end itemize
15622 @end table
15623
15624 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
15625 @section Easy Templates
15626 @cindex template insertion
15627 @cindex insertion, of templates
15628
15629 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
15630 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
15631 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
15632 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
15633 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
15634
15635 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
15636 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
15637 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
15638
15639 The following template selectors are currently supported.
15640
15641 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
15642 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
15643 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
15644 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
15645 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
15646 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
15647 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
15648 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
15649 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
15650 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
15651 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
15652 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
15653 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
15654 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
15655 @end multitable
15656
15657 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
15658 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
15659
15660 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
15661 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
15662 additional details.
15663
15664 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
15665 @section Speed keys
15666 @cindex speed keys
15667 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
15668 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
15669
15670 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
15671 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
15672 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
15673 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
15674 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
15675 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
15676 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
15677 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
15678
15679 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
15680 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
15681
15682 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
15683 @section Code evaluation and security issues
15684
15685 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
15686
15687 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
15688 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
15689 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
15690 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
15691 these precautions intact.
15692
15693 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
15694 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
15695 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
15696
15697 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
15698
15699 @table @i
15700 @item Source code blocks
15701 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
15702 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
15703 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
15704 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
15705 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
15706
15707 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
15708 which take off the default security brakes.
15709
15710 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
15711 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
15712 When @code{nil}, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
15713 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
15714 ask and @code{nil} not to ask.
15715 @end defopt
15716
15717 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
15718 without asking:
15719
15720 @lisp
15721 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
15722 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
15723 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
15724 @end lisp
15725
15726 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
15727 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
15728 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
15729 not visible.
15730
15731 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
15732 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
15733 @end defopt
15734 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
15735 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
15736 @end defopt
15737
15738 @item Formulas in tables
15739 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
15740 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
15741 @end table
15742
15743 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
15744 @section Customization
15745 @cindex customization
15746 @cindex options, for customization
15747 @cindex variables, for customization
15748
15749 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
15750 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
15751 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
15752 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize RET}. Or select
15753 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
15754 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
15755 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
15756
15757 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
15758 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
15759 @cindex in-buffer settings
15760 @cindex special keywords
15761
15762 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
15763 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
15764 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
15765 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
15766 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
15767 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
15768 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
15769 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
15770 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
15771
15772 @vindex org-archive-location
15773 @table @kbd
15774 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
15775 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
15776 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
15777 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
15778 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
15779 @item #+CATEGORY:
15780 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
15781 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
15782 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
15783 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
15784 @cindex property, COLUMNS
15785 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
15786 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
15787 applies.
15788 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
15789 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15790 @vindex org-table-formula
15791 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
15792 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
15793 The global version of this variable is
15794 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
15795 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
15796 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
15797 top-level entries.
15798 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
15799 @vindex org-drawers
15800 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
15801 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
15802 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
15803 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
15804 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
15805 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
15806 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
15807 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
15808 @vindex org-highest-priority
15809 @vindex org-lowest-priority
15810 @vindex org-default-priority
15811 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
15812 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
15813 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
15814 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
15815 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
15816 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
15817 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
15818 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
15819 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
15820 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
15821 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
15822 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
15823 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
15824 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
15825 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
15826 @item #+STARTUP:
15827 @cindex #+STARTUP
15828 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
15829 Org file is being visited.
15830
15831 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
15832 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
15833 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
15834 @code{overview}.
15835 @vindex org-startup-folded
15836 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
15837 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
15838 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
15839 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
15840 @example
15841 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
15842 content @r{all headlines}
15843 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
15844 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
15845 @end example
15846
15847 @vindex org-startup-indented
15848 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
15849 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
15850 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
15851 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
15852 @example
15853 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
15854 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
15855 @end example
15856
15857 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
15858 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
15859 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
15860 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
15861 @code{nil}.
15862 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
15863 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
15864 @example
15865 align @r{align all tables}
15866 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
15867 @end example
15868
15869 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
15870 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
15871 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
15872 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
15873 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
15874 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
15875 @example
15876 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
15877 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
15878 @end example
15879
15880 @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview
15881 When visiting a file, @LaTeX{} fragments can be converted to images
15882 automatically. The variable @code{org-startup-with-latex-preview} which
15883 controls this behavior, is set to @code{nil} by default to avoid delays on
15884 startup.
15885 @cindex @code{latexpreview}, STARTUP keyword
15886 @cindex @code{nolatexpreview}, STARTUP keyword
15887 @example
15888 latexpreview @r{preview @LaTeX{} fragments}
15889 nolatexpreview @r{don't preview @LaTeX{} fragments}
15890 @end example
15891
15892 @vindex org-log-done
15893 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
15894 @vindex org-log-repeat
15895 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
15896 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
15897 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
15898 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
15899 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
15900 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
15901 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
15902 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
15903 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
15904 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
15905 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
15906 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
15907 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
15908 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
15909 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
15910 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
15911 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
15912 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
15913 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
15914 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
15915 @cindex @code{logdrawer}, STARTUP keyword
15916 @cindex @code{nologdrawer}, STARTUP keyword
15917 @cindex @code{logstatesreversed}, STARTUP keyword
15918 @cindex @code{nologstatesreversed}, STARTUP keyword
15919 @example
15920 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
15921 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
15922 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
15923 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
15924 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
15925 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
15926 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
15927 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
15928 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
15929 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
15930 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
15931 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
15932 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
15933 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
15934 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
15935 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
15936 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
15937 logdrawer @r{store log into drawer}
15938 nologdrawer @r{store log outside of drawer}
15939 logstatesreversed @r{reverse the order of states notes}
15940 nologstatesreversed @r{do not reverse the order of states notes}
15941 @end example
15942
15943 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15944 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15945 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
15946 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
15947 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
15948 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
15949 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
15950 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
15951 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
15952 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
15953 @example
15954 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
15955 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
15956 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
15957 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
15958 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
15959 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
15960 @end example
15961
15962 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
15963 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
15964 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
15965 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
15966 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
15967 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
15968 @example
15969 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
15970 @end example
15971
15972 @vindex constants-unit-system
15973 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
15974 @code{constants-unit-system}).
15975 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
15976 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
15977 @example
15978 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
15979 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
15980 @end example
15981
15982 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
15983 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
15984 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
15985 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
15986 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
15987 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
15988 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
15989 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
15990 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
15991 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
15992 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
15993 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
15994 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
15995 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
15996 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
15997 @example
15998 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
15999 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
16000 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
16001 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
16002 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
16003 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
16004 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
16005 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
16006 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
16007 @end example
16008
16009 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
16010 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
16011 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
16012 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
16013 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
16014 @example
16015 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
16016 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
16017 @end example
16018
16019 @cindex org-pretty-entities
16020 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
16021 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
16022 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
16023 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
16024 @example
16025 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
16026 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
16027 @end example
16028
16029 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
16030 @vindex org-tag-alist
16031 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
16032 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
16033 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
16034 @cindex #+TBLFM
16035 @item #+TBLFM:
16036 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
16037
16038 Table can have multiple lines containing @samp{#+TBLFM:}. Note
16039 that only the first line of @samp{#+TBLFM:} will be applied when
16040 you recalculate the table. For more details see @ref{Using
16041 multiple #+TBLFM lines} in @ref{Editing and debugging formulas}.
16042
16043 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+DATE:,
16044 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:,
16045 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
16046 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+LaTeX_HEADER_EXTRA:,
16047 @itemx #+HTML_HEAD:, #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA:, #+HTML_LINK_UP:, #+HTML_LINK_HOME:,
16048 @itemx #+SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXCLUDE_TAGS:
16049 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
16050 @ref{Export settings}.
16051 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
16052 @vindex org-todo-keywords
16053 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
16054 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
16055 @end table
16056
16057 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
16058 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
16059 @kindex C-c C-c
16060 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
16061
16062 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
16063 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
16064 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
16065 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
16066 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
16067 what this means in different contexts.
16068
16069 @itemize @minus
16070 @item
16071 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
16072 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
16073 @item
16074 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
16075 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
16076 information.
16077 @item
16078 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
16079 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
16080 @item
16081 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
16082 the entire table.
16083 @item
16084 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
16085 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
16086 default location.
16087 @item
16088 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
16089 corresponding links in this buffer.
16090 @item
16091 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
16092 drawer, offer property commands.
16093 @item
16094 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
16095 definition, and @emph{vice versa}.
16096 @item
16097 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
16098 @item
16099 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
16100 of the checkbox.
16101 @item
16102 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
16103 ordered list.
16104 @item
16105 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
16106 block is updated.
16107 @item
16108 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
16109 @end itemize
16110
16111 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
16112 @section A cleaner outline view
16113 @cindex hiding leading stars
16114 @cindex dynamic indentation
16115 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
16116 @cindex clean outline view
16117
16118 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
16119 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
16120 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
16121 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
16122 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
16123
16124 @example
16125 @group
16126 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
16127 ** Second level | * Second level
16128 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
16129 some text | some text
16130 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
16131 more text | more text
16132 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
16133 @end group
16134 @end example
16135
16136 @noindent
16137
16138 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
16139 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
16140 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
16141 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
16142 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
16143 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
16144 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
16145 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
16146 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
16147 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
16148 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
16149 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
16150 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
16151 @code{nil}.}; see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
16152 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
16153 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
16154 individual files using
16155
16156 @example
16157 #+STARTUP: indent
16158 @end example
16159
16160 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
16161 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
16162 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
16163 the following way:
16164
16165 @enumerate
16166 @item
16167 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
16168 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
16169 with the headline, like
16170
16171 @example
16172 *** 3rd level
16173 more text, now indented
16174 @end example
16175
16176 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
16177 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
16178 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
16179 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
16180
16181 @item
16182 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
16183 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
16184 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
16185 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
16186 with
16187
16188 @example
16189 #+STARTUP: hidestars
16190 #+STARTUP: showstars
16191 @end example
16192
16193 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
16194
16195 @example
16196 @group
16197 * Top level headline
16198 * Second level
16199 * 3rd level
16200 ...
16201 @end group
16202 @end example
16203
16204 @noindent
16205 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
16206 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
16207 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
16208 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
16209 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
16210 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
16211 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
16212
16213 @item
16214 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16215 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
16216 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
16217 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
16218 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
16219 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
16220 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
16221 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
16222 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
16223
16224 @example
16225 #+STARTUP: odd
16226 #+STARTUP: oddeven
16227 @end example
16228
16229 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
16230 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
16231 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
16232 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
16233 @end enumerate
16234
16235 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
16236 @section Using Org on a tty
16237 @cindex tty key bindings
16238
16239 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
16240 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
16241 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
16242 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
16243 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
16244 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
16245 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
16246 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
16247 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
16248 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
16249 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
16250
16251 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
16252 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
16253 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
16254 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
16255 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
16256 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
16257 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
16258 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
16259 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
16260 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
16261 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
16262 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16263 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
16264 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16265 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16266 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16267 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16268 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16269 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16270 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
16271 @end multitable
16272
16273
16274 @node Interaction, org-crypt, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
16275 @section Interaction with other packages
16276 @cindex packages, interaction with other
16277 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
16278 with other code out there.
16279
16280 @menu
16281 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
16282 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
16283 @end menu
16284
16285 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
16286 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
16287
16288 @table @asis
16289 @cindex @file{calc.el}
16290 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
16291 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
16292 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
16293 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
16294 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
16295 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
16296 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
16297 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
16298 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
16299 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
16300 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
16301 @cindex @file{constants.el}
16302 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
16303 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
16304 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
16305 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
16306 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
16307 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
16308 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
16309 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
16310 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
16311 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
16312 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
16313 @file{constants.el}.
16314 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
16315 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
16316 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
16317 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
16318 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
16319 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
16320 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
16321 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
16322 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
16323 @lisp
16324 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
16325 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
16326 @end lisp
16327 @vindex org-imenu-depth
16328 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
16329 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
16330 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
16331 @cindex @file{remember.el}
16332 @cindex Wiegley, John
16333 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
16334 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
16335 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
16336 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
16337 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
16338 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
16339 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
16340 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
16341 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
16342 @cindex @file{table.el}
16343 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
16344 @kindex C-c C-c
16345 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
16346 @cindex @file{table.el}
16347 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
16348
16349 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
16350 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
16351 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
16352 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
16353 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
16354 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
16355 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
16356
16357 @table @kbd
16358 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
16359 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
16360 @c
16361 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
16362 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
16363 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
16364 format. See the documentation string of the command
16365 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
16366 possible.
16367 @end table
16368 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
16369 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
16370 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
16371 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
16372 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
16373 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
16374 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
16375 @end table
16376
16377 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
16378 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
16379
16380 @table @asis
16381
16382 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
16383 @vindex org-support-shift-select
16384 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
16385 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
16386 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
16387 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
16388 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
16389 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
16390 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
16391 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
16392 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
16393 cursor moves across a special context.
16394
16395 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
16396 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
16397 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
16398 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
16399 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
16400 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
16401 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
16402 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
16403 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
16404 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
16405 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
16406 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
16407 buffer (but not during date selection).
16408
16409 @example
16410 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
16411 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
16412 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
16413 @end example
16414
16415 @vindex org-disputed-keys
16416 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
16417 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
16418 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
16419
16420 @item @file{ecomplete.el} by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen @email{larsi@@gnus.org}
16421 @cindex @file{ecomplete.el}
16422
16423 Ecomplete provides ``electric'' address completion in address header
16424 lines in message buffers. Sadly Orgtbl mode cuts ecompletes power
16425 supply: No completion happens when Orgtbl mode is enabled in message
16426 buffers while entering text in address header lines. If one wants to
16427 use ecomplete one should @emph{not} follow the advice to automagically
16428 turn on Orgtbl mode in message buffers (see @ref{Orgtbl mode}), but
16429 instead---after filling in the message headers---turn on Orgtbl mode
16430 manually when needed in the messages body.
16431
16432 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
16433 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
16434
16435 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
16436 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
16437 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
16438 this:
16439
16440 @lisp
16441 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
16442 @end lisp
16443
16444 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
16445 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
16446 The way Org mode binds the @key{TAB} key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
16447 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
16448 fixed this problem:
16449
16450 @lisp
16451 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
16452 (lambda ()
16453 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
16454 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
16455 @end lisp
16456
16457 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
16458 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
16459 function:
16460
16461 @lisp
16462 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
16463 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
16464 @end lisp
16465
16466 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
16467
16468 @lisp
16469 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
16470 (lambda ()
16471 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
16472 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
16473 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
16474 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
16475 @end lisp
16476
16477 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
16478 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
16479 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
16480 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
16481 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
16482 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
16483 configuration:
16484
16485 @lisp
16486 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
16487 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
16488 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
16489 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
16490 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
16491 @end lisp
16492
16493 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
16494 @cindex @file{viper.el}
16495 @kindex C-c /
16496 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
16497 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
16498 another key for this command, or override the key in
16499 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
16500
16501 @lisp
16502 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
16503 @end lisp
16504
16505
16506
16507 @end table
16508
16509 @node org-crypt, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
16510 @section org-crypt.el
16511 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
16512 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
16513
16514 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
16515 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
16516 files.
16517
16518 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
16519 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
16520 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
16521
16522 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
16523 @file{.emacs}:
16524
16525 @lisp
16526 (require 'org-crypt)
16527 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
16528 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
16529
16530 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
16531 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
16532 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
16533
16534 (setq auto-save-default nil)
16535 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
16536 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
16537 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
16538 ;; start Org.
16539
16540 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
16541 ;;
16542 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
16543 @end lisp
16544
16545 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
16546 being encrypted again.
16547
16548 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
16549 @appendix Hacking
16550 @cindex hacking
16551
16552 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
16553 Org.
16554
16555 @menu
16556 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
16557 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
16558 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
16559 * Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends
16560 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
16561 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
16562 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
16563 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
16564 * Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas
16565 * Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information
16566 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
16567 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
16568 @end menu
16569
16570 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
16571 @section Hooks
16572 @cindex hooks
16573
16574 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
16575 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
16576 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
16577 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
16578 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
16579
16580 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
16581 @section Add-on packages
16582 @cindex add-on packages
16583
16584 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
16585
16586 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
16587 packages with the separate release available at @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
16588 See the @file{contrib/README} file in the source code directory for a list of
16589 contributed files. You may also find some more information on the Worg page:
16590 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
16591
16592 @node Adding hyperlink types, Adding export back-ends, Add-on packages, Hacking
16593 @section Adding hyperlink types
16594 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
16595
16596 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
16597 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
16598 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
16599 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
16600 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
16601 Emacs:
16602
16603 @lisp
16604 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
16605
16606 (require 'org)
16607
16608 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
16609 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
16610
16611 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
16612 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
16613 :group 'org-link
16614 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
16615
16616 (defun org-man-open (path)
16617 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
16618 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
16619 (funcall org-man-command path))
16620
16621 (defun org-man-store-link ()
16622 "Store a link to a manpage."
16623 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
16624 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
16625 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
16626 (link (concat "man:" page))
16627 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
16628 (org-store-link-props
16629 :type "man"
16630 :link link
16631 :description description))))
16632
16633 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
16634 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
16635 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
16636 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
16637 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
16638 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
16639
16640 (provide 'org-man)
16641
16642 ;;; org-man.el ends here
16643 @end lisp
16644
16645 @noindent
16646 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
16647
16648 @lisp
16649 (require 'org-man)
16650 @end lisp
16651
16652 @noindent
16653 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
16654 @enumerate
16655 @item
16656 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
16657 loaded.
16658 @item
16659 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
16660 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
16661 that will be called to follow such a link.
16662 @item
16663 @vindex org-store-link-functions
16664 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
16665 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
16666 buffer displaying a man page.
16667 @end enumerate
16668
16669 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
16670 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
16671 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
16672 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
16673 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
16674 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
16675 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
16676
16677 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
16678 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
16679 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
16680 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
16681 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
16682 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
16683 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
16684 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
16685 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
16686 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
16687 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
16688 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
16689
16690 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
16691 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
16692 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
16693 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
16694
16695 @node Adding export back-ends, Context-sensitive commands, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
16696 @section Adding export back-ends
16697 @cindex Export, writing back-ends
16698
16699 Org 8.0 comes with a completely rewritten export engine which makes it easy
16700 to write new export back-ends, either from scratch, or from deriving them
16701 from existing ones.
16702
16703 Your two entry points are respectively @code{org-export-define-backend} and
16704 @code{org-export-define-derived-backend}. To grok these functions, you
16705 should first have a look at @file{ox-latex.el} (for how to define a new
16706 back-end from scratch) and @file{ox-beamer.el} (for how to derive a new
16707 back-end from an existing one.
16708
16709 When creating a new back-end from scratch, the basic idea is to set the name
16710 of the back-end (as a symbol) and an an alist of elements and export
16711 functions. On top of this, you will need to set additional keywords like
16712 @code{:menu-entry} (to display the back-end in the export dispatcher),
16713 @code{:export-block} (to specify what blocks should not be exported by this
16714 back-end), and @code{:options-alist} (to let the user set export options that
16715 are specific to this back-end.)
16716
16717 Deriving a new back-end is similar, except that you need to set
16718 @code{:translate-alist} to an alist of export functions that should be used
16719 instead of the parent back-end functions.
16720
16721 For a complete reference documentation, see
16722 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-export-reference.html, the Org Export
16723 Reference on Worg}.
16724
16725 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding export back-ends, Hacking
16726 @section Context-sensitive commands
16727 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
16728 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
16729 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
16730
16731 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
16732 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
16733 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
16734
16735 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
16736 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
16737 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
16738 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
16739 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
16740 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
16741 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
16742 @code{#+RR:}.
16743
16744 @lisp
16745 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
16746 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
16747 (if (save-excursion
16748 (beginning-of-line 1)
16749 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
16750 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
16751 t) ;; to signal that we took action
16752 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
16753
16754 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
16755 @end lisp
16756
16757 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
16758 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
16759 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
16760 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
16761 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
16762
16763
16764 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
16765 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
16766 @cindex tables, in other modes
16767 @cindex lists, in other modes
16768 @cindex Orgtbl mode
16769
16770 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
16771 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
16772 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
16773 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
16774 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
16775 editor.
16776
16777 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
16778 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
16779 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
16780 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
16781 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
16782 for a very flexible system.
16783
16784 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
16785 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
16786 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
16787 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
16788
16789
16790 @menu
16791 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
16792 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
16793 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
16794 * Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists
16795 @end menu
16796
16797 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
16798 @subsection Radio tables
16799 @cindex radio tables
16800
16801 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
16802 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words
16803 @code{BEGIN/END RECEIVE ORGTBL} for Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will
16804 insert the translated table between these lines, replacing whatever was there
16805 before. For example in C mode where comments are between @code{/* ... */}:
16806
16807 @example
16808 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
16809 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
16810 @end example
16811
16812 @noindent
16813 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
16814 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
16815 example:
16816 @cindex #+ORGTBL
16817 @example
16818 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
16819 @end example
16820
16821 @noindent
16822 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
16823 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
16824 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
16825 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
16826 passed as a property list to the translation function for
16827 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
16828 acted upon before the translation function is called:
16829
16830 @table @code
16831 @item :skip N
16832 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
16833 this parameter!
16834
16835 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
16836 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
16837 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
16838 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
16839 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
16840 additional columns.
16841
16842 @item :no-escape t
16843 When non-@code{nil}, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
16844 the table. The default value is @code{nil}.
16845 @end table
16846
16847 @noindent
16848 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
16849 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
16850 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
16851 number of different solutions:
16852
16853 @itemize @bullet
16854 @item
16855 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
16856 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
16857 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
16858 @item
16859 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
16860 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
16861 in @LaTeX{}.
16862 @item
16863 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
16864 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
16865 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment RET}
16866 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
16867 key.
16868 @end itemize
16869
16870 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
16871 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
16872 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
16873
16874 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
16875 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
16876 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
16877 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
16878 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
16879 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-table-templates} to install templates for other
16880 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table RET}. You will
16881 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
16882 will then get the following template:
16883
16884 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
16885 @example
16886 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16887 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16888 \begin@{comment@}
16889 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
16890 | | |
16891 \end@{comment@}
16892 @end example
16893
16894 @noindent
16895 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
16896 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
16897 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
16898 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
16899 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
16900 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
16901 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
16902 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
16903 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
16904 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
16905 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
16906 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
16907
16908 @example
16909 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16910 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16911 \begin@{comment@}
16912 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
16913 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
16914 |-------+------+---------+---------|
16915 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
16916 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
16917 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
16918 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
16919 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
16920 \end@{comment@}
16921 @end example
16922
16923 @noindent
16924 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
16925 table inserted between the two marker lines.
16926
16927 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
16928 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
16929 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
16930 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
16931 header and footer commands of the target table:
16932
16933 @example
16934 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
16935 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
16936 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16937 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16938 \end@{tabular@}
16939 %
16940 \begin@{comment@}
16941 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
16942 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
16943 |-------+------+---------+---------|
16944 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
16945 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
16946 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
16947 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
16948 \end@{comment@}
16949 @end example
16950
16951 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
16952 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
16953 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
16954 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
16955
16956 @table @code
16957 @item :splice nil/t
16958 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
16959 tabular environment. Default is @code{nil}.
16960
16961 @item :fmt fmt
16962 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
16963 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
16964 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
16965 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
16966 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
16967 function must return a formatted string.
16968
16969 @item :efmt efmt
16970 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
16971 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
16972 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
16973 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
16974 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
16975 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
16976 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
16977 supplied instead of strings.
16978 @end table
16979
16980 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
16981 @subsection Translator functions
16982 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
16983 @cindex translator function
16984
16985 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
16986 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
16987 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
16988 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
16989 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
16990 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
16991 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
16992 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
16993 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
16994
16995 @lisp
16996 @group
16997 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
16998 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
16999 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
17000 org-table-last-alignment ""))
17001 (params2
17002 (list
17003 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
17004 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
17005 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
17006 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
17007 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
17008 @end group
17009 @end lisp
17010
17011 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
17012 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
17013 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
17014 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
17015 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
17016 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
17017 overrule the default with
17018
17019 @example
17020 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
17021 @end example
17022
17023 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
17024 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
17025 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
17026 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
17027 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
17028 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
17029 a single line!):
17030
17031 @example
17032 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
17033 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
17034 @end example
17035
17036 @noindent
17037 Please check the documentation string of the function
17038 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
17039 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
17040 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
17041 using the generic function.
17042
17043 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
17044 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
17045 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
17046 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
17047 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
17048 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
17049 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
17050 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
17051 others can benefit from your work.
17052
17053 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
17054 @subsection Radio lists
17055 @cindex radio lists
17056 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
17057
17058 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
17059 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
17060 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
17061 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
17062
17063 Here are the differences with radio tables:
17064
17065 @itemize @minus
17066 @item
17067 Orgstruct mode must be active.
17068 @item
17069 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
17070 @item
17071 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
17072 parameters.
17073 @item
17074 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
17075 @end itemize
17076
17077 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
17078 @LaTeX{} file:
17079
17080 @cindex #+ORGLST
17081 @example
17082 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
17083 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
17084 \begin@{comment@}
17085 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
17086 - a new house
17087 - a new computer
17088 + a new keyboard
17089 + a new mouse
17090 - a new life
17091 \end@{comment@}
17092 @end example
17093
17094 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
17095 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
17096
17097 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
17098 @section Dynamic blocks
17099 @cindex dynamic blocks
17100
17101 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
17102 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
17103 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
17104 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
17105
17106 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
17107 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
17108 the content of the block.
17109
17110 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
17111 @example
17112 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
17113
17114 #+END:
17115 @end example
17116
17117 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
17118
17119 @table @kbd
17120 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
17121 Update dynamic block at point.
17122 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
17123 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
17124 @end table
17125
17126 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
17127 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
17128 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
17129 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
17130 extra parameter @code{:content}.
17131
17132 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
17133 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
17134 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
17135 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
17136 run:
17137
17138 @example
17139 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
17140
17141 #+END:
17142 @end example
17143
17144 @noindent
17145 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
17146
17147 @lisp
17148 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
17149 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
17150 (insert "Last block update at: "
17151 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
17152 @end lisp
17153
17154 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
17155 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
17156 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
17157 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
17158 @code{org-mode}.
17159
17160 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
17161 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
17162
17163 @node Special agenda views, Speeding up your agendas, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
17164 @section Special agenda views
17165 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
17166
17167 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
17168 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
17169 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
17170 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{agenda*}@footnote{The
17171 @code{agenda*} view is the same than @code{agenda} except that it only
17172 considers @emph{appointments}, i.e., scheduled and deadline items that have a
17173 time specification @code{[h]h:mm} in their time-stamps.}, @code{todo},
17174 @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may
17175 specify a function that is used at each match to verify if the match should
17176 indeed be part of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
17177 You can specify a global condition that will be applied to all agenda views,
17178 this condition would be stored in the variable
17179 @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More commonly, such a definition is
17180 applied only to specific custom searches, using
17181 @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
17182
17183 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
17184 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
17185 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
17186 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
17187 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
17188 the subtree belonging to the project line.
17189
17190 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
17191 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
17192 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
17193 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
17194 search should continue from there.
17195
17196 @lisp
17197 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
17198 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
17199 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
17200 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
17201 nil ; tag found, do not skip
17202 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
17203 @end lisp
17204
17205 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
17206 like this:
17207
17208 @lisp
17209 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
17210 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
17211 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
17212 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
17213 @end lisp
17214
17215 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
17216 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
17217 meaningful header in the agenda view.
17218
17219 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
17220 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
17221 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
17222 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
17223 your custom search function, simply do a search for
17224 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
17225 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
17226 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
17227 you really want to have.
17228
17229 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
17230 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
17231 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
17232
17233 @table @code
17234 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
17235 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
17236 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
17237 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
17238 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
17239 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
17240 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
17241 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
17242 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
17243 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
17244 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
17245 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
17246 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
17247 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
17248 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
17249 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
17250 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
17251 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
17252 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
17253 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
17254 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
17255 @end table
17256
17257 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
17258 like this, even without defining a special function:
17259
17260 @lisp
17261 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
17262 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
17263 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
17264 'regexp ":waiting:"))
17265 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
17266 @end lisp
17267
17268 @node Speeding up your agendas, Extracting agenda information, Special agenda views, Hacking
17269 @section Speeding up your agendas
17270 @cindex agenda views, optimization
17271
17272 When your Org files grow in both number and size, agenda commands may start
17273 to become slow. Below are some tips on how to speed up the agenda commands.
17274
17275 @enumerate
17276 @item
17277 Reduce the number of Org agenda files: this will reduce the slowness caused
17278 by accessing a hard drive.
17279 @item
17280 Reduce the number of DONE and archived headlines: this way the agenda does
17281 not need to skip them.
17282 @item
17283 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
17284 Inhibit the dimming of blocked tasks:
17285 @lisp
17286 (setq org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks nil)
17287 @end lisp
17288 @item
17289 @vindex org-startup-folded
17290 @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup
17291 Inhibit agenda files startup options:
17292 @lisp
17293 (setq org-agenda-inhibit-startup nil)
17294 @end lisp
17295 @item
17296 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
17297 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
17298 Disable tag inheritance in agenda:
17299 @lisp
17300 (setq org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance nil)
17301 @end lisp
17302 @end enumerate
17303
17304 You can set these options for specific agenda views only. See the docstrings
17305 of these variables for details on why they affect the agenda generation, and
17306 this @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/agenda-optimization.html, dedicated Worg
17307 page} for further explanations.
17308
17309 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Speeding up your agendas, Hacking
17310 @section Extracting agenda information
17311 @cindex agenda, pipe
17312 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
17313
17314 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
17315 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
17316 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
17317 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
17318 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
17319 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
17320 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
17321 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
17322 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
17323 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
17324 current TODO list, you could use
17325
17326 @example
17327 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
17328 @end example
17329
17330 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
17331 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
17332 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
17333 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
17334
17335 @example
17336 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
17337 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
17338 @end example
17339
17340 @noindent
17341 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
17342
17343 @example
17344 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
17345 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
17346 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
17347 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
17348 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
17349 | lpr
17350 @end example
17351
17352 @noindent
17353 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
17354 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
17355
17356 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
17357 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
17358 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
17359 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
17360 are:
17361
17362 @example
17363 category @r{The category of the item}
17364 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
17365 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
17366 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
17367 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
17368 diary @r{imported from diary}
17369 deadline @r{a deadline}
17370 scheduled @r{scheduled}
17371 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
17372 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
17373 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
17374 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
17375 block @r{entry has date block including date}
17376 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
17377 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
17378 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
17379 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
17380 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
17381 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
17382 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
17383 @end example
17384
17385 @noindent
17386 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
17387 led to the selection of the item.
17388
17389 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
17390 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
17391 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
17392
17393 @example
17394 #!/usr/bin/perl
17395
17396 # define the Emacs command to run
17397 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
17398
17399 # run it and capture the output
17400 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
17401
17402 # loop over all lines
17403 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
17404 # get the individual values
17405 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
17406 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
17407 # process and print
17408 print "[ ] $head\n";
17409 @}
17410 @end example
17411
17412 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
17413 @section Using the property API
17414 @cindex API, for properties
17415 @cindex properties, API
17416
17417 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
17418 properties.
17419
17420 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
17421 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
17422 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
17423 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
17424 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
17425 if the property key was used several times.@*
17426 POM may also be @code{nil}, in which case the current entry is used.
17427 If WHICH is @code{nil} or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
17428 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
17429 @end defun
17430 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
17431 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
17432 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
17433 Get value of @code{PROPERTY} for entry at point-or-marker @code{POM}@. By default,
17434 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If @code{INHERIT}
17435 is non-@code{nil} and the entry does not have the property, then also check
17436 higher levels of the hierarchy. If @code{INHERIT} is the symbol
17437 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
17438 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects @code{PROPERTY} for inheritance.
17439 @end defun
17440
17441 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
17442 Delete the property @code{PROPERTY} from entry at point-or-marker POM.
17443 @end defun
17444
17445 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
17446 Set @code{PROPERTY} to @code{VALUE} for entry at point-or-marker POM.
17447 @end defun
17448
17449 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
17450 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
17451 @end defun
17452
17453 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
17454 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
17455 @end defun
17456
17457 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
17458 Set @code{PROPERTY} at point-or-marker @code{POM} to @code{VALUES}@.
17459 @code{VALUES} should be a list of strings. They will be concatenated, with
17460 spaces as separators.
17461 @end defun
17462
17463 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
17464 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
17465 list of values and return the values as a list of strings.
17466 @end defun
17467
17468 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
17469 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
17470 list of values and make sure that @code{VALUE} is in this list.
17471 @end defun
17472
17473 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
17474 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
17475 list of values and make sure that @code{VALUE} is @emph{not} in this list.
17476 @end defun
17477
17478 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
17479 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
17480 list of values and check if @code{VALUE} is in this list.
17481 @end defun
17482
17483 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
17484 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
17485 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
17486 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
17487 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
17488 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
17489 responsible for this property.
17490 @end defopt
17491
17492 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
17493 @section Using the mapping API
17494 @cindex API, for mapping
17495 @cindex mapping entries, API
17496
17497 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
17498 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
17499 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
17500 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
17501 is:
17502
17503 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
17504 Call @code{FUNC} at each headline selected by @code{MATCH} in @code{SCOPE}.
17505
17506 @code{FUNC} is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called
17507 without arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the
17508 headline. The return values of all calls to the function will be collected
17509 and returned as a list.
17510
17511 The call to @code{FUNC} will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so
17512 @code{FUNC} does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor
17513 will be moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
17514 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some circumstances,
17515 this may not produce the wanted results. For example, if you have removed
17516 (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could mean that the next entry will
17517 be skipped entirely. In such cases, you can specify the position from where
17518 search should continue by making @code{FUNC} set the variable
17519 @code{org-map-continue-from} to the desired buffer position.
17520
17521 @code{MATCH} is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match
17522 view. Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered
17523 during the iteration. When @code{MATCH} is @code{nil} or @code{t}, all
17524 headlines will be visited by the iteration.
17525
17526 @code{SCOPE} determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
17527
17528 @example
17529 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
17530 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
17531 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
17532 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
17533 file-with-archives
17534 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
17535 agenda @r{all agenda files}
17536 agenda-with-archives
17537 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
17538 (file1 file2 ...)
17539 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
17540 @end example
17541 @noindent
17542 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
17543 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
17544
17545 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
17546 @example
17547 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
17548 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
17549 function or Lisp form
17550 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
17551 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
17552 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
17553 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
17554 @end example
17555 @end defun
17556
17557 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
17558 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
17559 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
17560 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
17561
17562 @defun org-todo &optional arg
17563 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
17564 the many possible values for the argument @code{ARG}.
17565 @end defun
17566
17567 @defun org-priority &optional action
17568 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
17569 possible values for @code{ACTION}.
17570 @end defun
17571
17572 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
17573 Toggle the tag @code{TAG} in the current entry. Setting @code{ONOFF} to
17574 either @code{on} or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is
17575 either on or off.
17576 @end defun
17577
17578 @defun org-promote
17579 Promote the current entry.
17580 @end defun
17581
17582 @defun org-demote
17583 Demote the current entry.
17584 @end defun
17585
17586 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
17587 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
17588 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
17589
17590 @lisp
17591 (org-map-entries
17592 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
17593 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
17594 @end lisp
17595
17596 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
17597 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
17598
17599 @lisp
17600 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
17601 @end lisp
17602
17603 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
17604 @appendix MobileOrg
17605 @cindex iPhone
17606 @cindex MobileOrg
17607
17608 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
17609 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
17610 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
17611 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries. The
17612 @uref{https://github.com/MobileOrg/, iOS implementation} for the
17613 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was started by Richard Moreland
17614 and is now in the hands Sean Escriva. Android users should check out
17615 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
17616 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
17617 features.
17618
17619 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
17620 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
17621 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
17622
17623 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
17624 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tag-alist} to
17625 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
17626 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
17627 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
17628 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
17629 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
17630
17631 @menu
17632 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
17633 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
17634 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
17635 @end menu
17636
17637 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
17638 @section Setting up the staging area
17639
17640 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
17641 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
17642 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
17643 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
17644 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
17645 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
17646 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
17647 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
17648 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
17649 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
17650 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
17651
17652 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
17653 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
17654 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
17655 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
17656 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
17657 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
17658 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
17659 Emacs about it:
17660
17661 @lisp
17662 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
17663 @end lisp
17664
17665 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
17666 and to read captured notes from there.
17667
17668 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
17669 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
17670
17671 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
17672 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
17673 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
17674 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
17675 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
17676 inside this directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} need to
17677 have the same name than their targets.}.
17678
17679 The push operation also creates a special Org file @file{agendas.org} with
17680 all custom agenda view defined by the user@footnote{While creating the
17681 agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on all referenced entries, so that
17682 these entries can be uniquely identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for
17683 further action. If you do not want to get these properties in so many
17684 entries, you can set the variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}
17685 to @code{nil}. Org mode will then rely on outline paths, in the hope that
17686 these will be unique enough.}.
17687
17688 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
17689 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
17690 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
17691 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
17692 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
17693
17694 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
17695 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
17696
17697 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
17698 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
17699 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
17700 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
17701 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
17702
17703 @enumerate
17704 @item
17705 Org moves all entries found in
17706 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
17707 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
17708 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
17709 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
17710 @item
17711 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
17712 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
17713 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
17714 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
17715 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
17716 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
17717 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
17718 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
17719 @item
17720 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
17721 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
17722 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
17723 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
17724 agenda line.
17725
17726 @table @kbd
17727 @kindex ?
17728 @item ?
17729 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
17730 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
17731 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
17732 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
17733 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
17734 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
17735 this flagged entry is finished.
17736 @end table
17737 @end enumerate
17738
17739 @kindex C-c a ?
17740 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
17741 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
17742 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull RET}
17743 is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the last pull.
17744 This might include a file that is not currently in your list of agenda files.
17745 If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only the current
17746 agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
17747
17748 @node History and Acknowledgments, GNU Free Documentation License, MobileOrg, Top
17749 @appendix History and acknowledgments
17750 @cindex acknowledgments
17751 @cindex history
17752 @cindex thanks
17753
17754 @section From Carsten
17755
17756 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
17757 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
17758 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
17759 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
17760 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
17761 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
17762 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
17763 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
17764 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
17765 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
17766 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
17767 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
17768 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
17769 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
17770 functionality directly into a notes file.
17771
17772 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
17773 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
17774 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
17775 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
17776 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
17777 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
17778 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
17779 let me know.
17780
17781 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
17782
17783 @table @i
17784 @item Bastien Guerry
17785 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
17786 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
17787 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
17788 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
17789 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
17790 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
17791 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
17792 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
17793 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
17794 programming and reproducible research.
17795 @item John Wiegley
17796 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
17797 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
17798 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
17799 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
17800 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
17801 of his great @file{remember.el}.
17802 @item Sebastian Rose
17803 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
17804 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
17805 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
17806 web pages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
17807 single-key navigation.
17808 @end table
17809
17810 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
17811 let me know what I am missing here!
17812
17813 @section From Bastien
17814
17815 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
17816 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
17817 to Carsten's ones above.
17818
17819 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
17820 maintainership of Org. His unremitting support is what really helped me
17821 getting more confident over time, with both the community and the code.
17822
17823 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
17824 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
17825 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
17826 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
17827 either of the code or the community:
17828
17829 @table @i
17830 @item Eric Schulte
17831 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
17832 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
17833
17834 @item Nicolas Goaziou
17835 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His
17836 work on @file{org-element.el} and @file{ox.el} has been outstanding, and
17837 opened the doors for many new ideas and features. He rewrote many of the
17838 old exporters to use the new export engine, and helped with documenting
17839 this major change. More importantly (if that's possible), he has been more
17840 than reliable during all the work done for Org 8.0, and always very
17841 reactive on the mailing list.
17842
17843 @item Achim Gratz
17844 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
17845 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
17846 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
17847
17848 @item Nick Dokos
17849 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
17850 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
17851 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
17852 @end table
17853
17854 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
17855 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
17856 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
17857
17858 @section List of contributions
17859
17860 @itemize @bullet
17861
17862 @item
17863 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
17864 @item
17865 @i{Suvayu Ali} has steadily helped on the mailing list, providing useful
17866 feedback on many features and several patches.
17867 @item
17868 @i{Luis Anaya} wrote @file{ox-man.el}.
17869 @item
17870 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
17871 @item
17872 @i{Michael Brand} helped by reporting many bugs and testing many features.
17873 He also implemented the distinction between empty fields and 0-value fields
17874 in Org's spreadsheets.
17875 @item
17876 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
17877 Org mode website.
17878 @item
17879 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
17880 @item
17881 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
17882 @item
17883 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
17884 @item
17885 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
17886 @item
17887 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
17888 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
17889 @item
17890 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
17891 specified time.
17892 @item
17893 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
17894 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
17895 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
17896 @item
17897 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
17898 @item
17899 @i{Toby S. Cubitt} contributed to the code for clock formats.
17900 @item
17901 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter. It has been deleted from
17902 Org 8.0: you can now export to Texinfo and export the @file{.texi} file to
17903 DocBook using @code{makeinfo}.
17904 @item
17905 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
17906 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
17907 them.
17908 @item
17909 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
17910 @item
17911 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
17912 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
17913 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
17914 @item
17915 @i{Jason Dunsmore} has been maintaining the Org-Mode server at Rackspace for
17916 several years now. He also sponsored the hosting costs until Rackspace
17917 started to host us for free.
17918 @item
17919 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
17920 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
17921 @item
17922 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
17923 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
17924 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}, which has been rewritten by Nicolas Goaziou as
17925 @file{ox-taskjuggler.el} for Org 8.0.
17926 @item
17927 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
17928 HTML agendas.
17929 @item
17930 @i{Sean Escriva} took over MobileOrg development on the iPhone platform.
17931 @item
17932 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
17933 @item
17934 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
17935 @item
17936 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
17937 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
17938 @item
17939 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
17940 @item
17941 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
17942 @item
17943 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
17944 @item
17945 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
17946 testing.
17947 @item
17948 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
17949 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
17950 @item
17951 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
17952 @item
17953 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code. He also wrote
17954 @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el}, which was a huge step forward
17955 in implementing a clean framework for Org exporters.
17956 @item
17957 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
17958 @item
17959 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
17960 book.
17961 @item
17962 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
17963 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
17964 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
17965 @item
17966 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
17967 patches.
17968 @item
17969 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
17970 @item
17971 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
17972 folded entries, and column view for properties.
17973 @item
17974 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
17975 @item
17976 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
17977 @item
17978 @i{Jonathan Leech-Pepin} wrote @file{ox-texinfo.el}.
17979 @item
17980 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
17981 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
17982 @item
17983 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
17984 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
17985 @item
17986 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
17987 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
17988 small fixes and patches.
17989 @item
17990 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
17991 @item
17992 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling and sticky agendas.
17993 @item
17994 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
17995 basis.
17996 @item
17997 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
17998 happy.
17999 @item
18000 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
18001 @item
18002 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
18003 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
18004 @item
18005 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
18006 @item
18007 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
18008 @item
18009 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
18010 file links, and TAGS.
18011 @item
18012 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
18013 version of the reference card.
18014 @item
18015 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
18016 into Japanese.
18017 @item
18018 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
18019 @item
18020 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
18021 links, among other things.
18022 @item
18023 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
18024 provided frequent feedback.
18025 @item
18026 @i{Francesco Pizzolante} provided patches that helped speeding up the agenda
18027 generation.
18028 @item
18029 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
18030 into bundles of 20 for undo.
18031 @item
18032 @i{Rackspace.com} is hosting our website for free. Thank you Rackspace!
18033 @item
18034 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
18035 @item
18036 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
18037 control.
18038 @item
18039 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
18040 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
18041 @item
18042 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
18043 @item
18044 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
18045 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
18046 @item
18047 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
18048 extensive patches.
18049 @item
18050 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
18051 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
18052 @item
18053 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
18054 other things.
18055 @item
18056 @i{Christopher Schmidt} reworked @code{orgstruct-mode} so that users can
18057 enjoy folding in non-org buffers by using Org headlines in comments.
18058 @item
18059 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
18060 @item
18061 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
18062 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
18063 @item
18064 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
18065 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
18066 @item
18067 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
18068 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
18069 @item
18070 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
18071 subtrees.
18072 @item
18073 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
18074 @item
18075 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
18076 tweaks and features.
18077 @item
18078 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
18079 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
18080 @item
18081 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
18082 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
18083 @item
18084 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
18085 with links transformation to Org syntax.
18086 @item
18087 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
18088 chapter about publishing.
18089 @item
18090 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter and rewrote the HTML exporter.
18091 @item
18092 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
18093 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
18094 @item
18095 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
18096 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
18097 concept index for HTML export.
18098 @item
18099 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
18100 in HTML output.
18101 @item
18102 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
18103 @item
18104 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
18105 keyword.
18106 @item
18107 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
18108 system.
18109 @item
18110 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
18111 linking to Gnus.
18112 @item
18113 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
18114 work on a tty.
18115 @item
18116 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
18117 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
18118 @end itemize
18119
18120
18121 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Main Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
18122 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
18123 @include doclicense.texi
18124
18125
18126 @node Main Index, Key Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
18127 @unnumbered Concept index
18128
18129 @printindex cp
18130
18131 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
18132 @unnumbered Key index
18133
18134 @printindex ky
18135
18136 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
18137 @unnumbered Command and function index
18138
18139 @printindex fn
18140
18141 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
18142 @unnumbered Variable index
18143
18144 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
18145 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
18146 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
18147
18148 @printindex vr
18149
18150 @bye
18151
18152 @c Local variables:
18153 @c fill-column: 77
18154 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
18155 @c paragraph-start: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
18156 @c paragraph-separate: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
18157 @c End:
18158
18159
18160 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre